Array indexed by non-contiguous enumeration types
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / ada-lang.c
1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1992-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20
21 #include "defs.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "demangle.h"
24 #include "gdb_regex.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "gdbtypes.h"
28 #include "gdbcmd.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "parser-defs.h"
31 #include "language.h"
32 #include "varobj.h"
33 #include "c-lang.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "symfile.h"
36 #include "objfiles.h"
37 #include "breakpoint.h"
38 #include "gdbcore.h"
39 #include "hashtab.h"
40 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
41 #include "ada-lang.h"
42 #include "completer.h"
43 #include <sys/stat.h>
44 #include "ui-out.h"
45 #include "block.h"
46 #include "infcall.h"
47 #include "dictionary.h"
48 #include "annotate.h"
49 #include "valprint.h"
50 #include "source.h"
51 #include "observer.h"
52 #include "vec.h"
53 #include "stack.h"
54 #include "gdb_vecs.h"
55 #include "typeprint.h"
56
57 #include "psymtab.h"
58 #include "value.h"
59 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
60 #include "arch-utils.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62
63 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
64 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
65 Copied from valarith.c. */
66
67 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
68 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
69 #endif
70
71 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
72
73 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
74
75 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
76
77 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
78
79 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
80
81 static struct type *desc_data_target_type (struct type *);
82
83 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
84
85 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
86
87 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
88
89 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
90
91 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
92
93 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
94
95 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
96
97 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
98
99 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
100
101 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
102
103 static int full_match (const char *, const char *);
104
105 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *);
106
107 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
108 const struct block *, const char *,
109 domain_enum, struct objfile *, int);
110
111 static int is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info *, int);
112
113 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
114 const struct block *);
115
116 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
117
118 static struct ada_symbol_info *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
119
120 static struct value *resolve_subexp (struct expression **, int *, int,
121 struct type *);
122
123 static void replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **, int, int, int,
124 struct symbol *, const struct block *);
125
126 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
127
128 static char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
129
130 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
131
132 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
133
134 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
135
136 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
137
138 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
139
140 static enum ada_renaming_category parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *,
141 const char **,
142 int *,
143 const char **);
144
145 static struct symbol *find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *,
146 const struct block *);
147
148 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, char *,
149 int, int, int *);
150
151 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
152
153 static struct type *ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *,
154 const char *);
155
156 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
157
158 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
159 const gdb_byte *,
160 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
161
162 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
163
164 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (struct type *, struct value *);
165
166 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
167 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
168
169 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
170
171 static struct type *constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
172
173 static struct type *decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
174
175 static long decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *);
176
177 static struct value *decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *);
178
179 static int ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *);
180
181 static int ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
182
183 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
184 struct value **);
185
186 static void move_bits (gdb_byte *, int, const gdb_byte *, int, int, int);
187
188 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
189 struct type *);
190
191 static struct value *get_var_value (char *, char *);
192
193 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
194
195 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
196
197 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
198
199 static int advance_wild_match (const char **, const char *, int);
200
201 static int wild_match (const char *, const char *);
202
203 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
204
205 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
206
207 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
208
209 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
210
211 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
212 domain_enum);
213
214 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (char *, struct value *, int,
215 struct type *);
216
217 static struct value *ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *, int, int,
218 struct type *);
219
220 static int find_struct_field (const char *, struct type *, int,
221 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
222
223 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *, CORE_ADDR,
224 struct value *);
225
226 static int ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info *, int,
227 struct value **, int, const char *,
228 struct type *);
229
230 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
231
232 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *,
233 struct language_arch_info *);
234
235 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
236 struct type *);
237
238 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
239 struct expression *,
240 int *, enum noside);
241
242 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
243 struct expression *,
244 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
245 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
246
247 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
248 struct expression *,
249 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
250 LONGEST, LONGEST);
251
252
253 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
254 struct expression *,
255 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
256
257
258 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
259
260
261 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
262 int *, enum noside);
263
264 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
265 int *);
266
267 static struct type *ada_find_any_type (const char *name);
268 \f
269
270 /* The result of a symbol lookup to be stored in our symbol cache. */
271
272 struct cache_entry
273 {
274 /* The name used to perform the lookup. */
275 const char *name;
276 /* The namespace used during the lookup. */
277 domain_enum domain;
278 /* The symbol returned by the lookup, or NULL if no matching symbol
279 was found. */
280 struct symbol *sym;
281 /* The block where the symbol was found, or NULL if no matching
282 symbol was found. */
283 const struct block *block;
284 /* A pointer to the next entry with the same hash. */
285 struct cache_entry *next;
286 };
287
288 /* The Ada symbol cache, used to store the result of Ada-mode symbol
289 lookups in the course of executing the user's commands.
290
291 The cache is implemented using a simple, fixed-sized hash.
292 The size is fixed on the grounds that there are not likely to be
293 all that many symbols looked up during any given session, regardless
294 of the size of the symbol table. If we decide to go to a resizable
295 table, let's just use the stuff from libiberty instead. */
296
297 #define HASH_SIZE 1009
298
299 struct ada_symbol_cache
300 {
301 /* An obstack used to store the entries in our cache. */
302 struct obstack cache_space;
303
304 /* The root of the hash table used to implement our symbol cache. */
305 struct cache_entry *root[HASH_SIZE];
306 };
307
308 static void ada_free_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache);
309
310 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
311 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
312
313 /* FIXME: brobecker/2003-09-17: No longer a const because it is
314 returned by a function that does not return a const char *. */
315 static char *ada_completer_word_break_characters =
316 #ifdef VMS
317 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
318 #else
319 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
320 #endif
321
322 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
323 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
324 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
325
326 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
327 static int warning_limit = 2;
328
329 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
330 expression evaluation. */
331 static int warnings_issued = 0;
332
333 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
334 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
335 };
336
337 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
338 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
339 };
340
341 /* Space for allocating results of ada_lookup_symbol_list. */
342 static struct obstack symbol_list_obstack;
343
344 /* Maintenance-related settings for this module. */
345
346 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_set_ada_cmdlist;
347 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_show_ada_cmdlist;
348
349 /* Implement the "maintenance set ada" (prefix) command. */
350
351 static void
352 maint_set_ada_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
353 {
354 help_list (maint_set_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance set ada ", all_commands,
355 gdb_stdout);
356 }
357
358 /* Implement the "maintenance show ada" (prefix) command. */
359
360 static void
361 maint_show_ada_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
362 {
363 cmd_show_list (maint_show_ada_cmdlist, from_tty, "");
364 }
365
366 /* The "maintenance ada set/show ignore-descriptive-type" value. */
367
368 static int ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p = 0;
369
370 /* Inferior-specific data. */
371
372 /* Per-inferior data for this module. */
373
374 struct ada_inferior_data
375 {
376 /* The ada__tags__type_specific_data type, which is used when decoding
377 tagged types. With older versions of GNAT, this type was directly
378 accessible through a component ("tsd") in the object tag. But this
379 is no longer the case, so we cache it for each inferior. */
380 struct type *tsd_type;
381
382 /* The exception_support_info data. This data is used to determine
383 how to implement support for Ada exception catchpoints in a given
384 inferior. */
385 const struct exception_support_info *exception_info;
386 };
387
388 /* Our key to this module's inferior data. */
389 static const struct inferior_data *ada_inferior_data;
390
391 /* A cleanup routine for our inferior data. */
392 static void
393 ada_inferior_data_cleanup (struct inferior *inf, void *arg)
394 {
395 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
396
397 data = inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data);
398 if (data != NULL)
399 xfree (data);
400 }
401
402 /* Return our inferior data for the given inferior (INF).
403
404 This function always returns a valid pointer to an allocated
405 ada_inferior_data structure. If INF's inferior data has not
406 been previously set, this functions creates a new one with all
407 fields set to zero, sets INF's inferior to it, and then returns
408 a pointer to that newly allocated ada_inferior_data. */
409
410 static struct ada_inferior_data *
411 get_ada_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf)
412 {
413 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
414
415 data = inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data);
416 if (data == NULL)
417 {
418 data = XCNEW (struct ada_inferior_data);
419 set_inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data, data);
420 }
421
422 return data;
423 }
424
425 /* Perform all necessary cleanups regarding our module's inferior data
426 that is required after the inferior INF just exited. */
427
428 static void
429 ada_inferior_exit (struct inferior *inf)
430 {
431 ada_inferior_data_cleanup (inf, NULL);
432 set_inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data, NULL);
433 }
434
435
436 /* program-space-specific data. */
437
438 /* This module's per-program-space data. */
439 struct ada_pspace_data
440 {
441 /* The Ada symbol cache. */
442 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache;
443 };
444
445 /* Key to our per-program-space data. */
446 static const struct program_space_data *ada_pspace_data_handle;
447
448 /* Return this module's data for the given program space (PSPACE).
449 If not is found, add a zero'ed one now.
450
451 This function always returns a valid object. */
452
453 static struct ada_pspace_data *
454 get_ada_pspace_data (struct program_space *pspace)
455 {
456 struct ada_pspace_data *data;
457
458 data = program_space_data (pspace, ada_pspace_data_handle);
459 if (data == NULL)
460 {
461 data = XCNEW (struct ada_pspace_data);
462 set_program_space_data (pspace, ada_pspace_data_handle, data);
463 }
464
465 return data;
466 }
467
468 /* The cleanup callback for this module's per-program-space data. */
469
470 static void
471 ada_pspace_data_cleanup (struct program_space *pspace, void *data)
472 {
473 struct ada_pspace_data *pspace_data = data;
474
475 if (pspace_data->sym_cache != NULL)
476 ada_free_symbol_cache (pspace_data->sym_cache);
477 xfree (pspace_data);
478 }
479
480 /* Utilities */
481
482 /* If TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF type, return the target type after
483 all typedef layers have been peeled. Otherwise, return TYPE.
484
485 Normally, we really expect a typedef type to only have 1 typedef layer.
486 In other words, we really expect the target type of a typedef type to be
487 a non-typedef type. This is particularly true for Ada units, because
488 the language does not have a typedef vs not-typedef distinction.
489 In that respect, the Ada compiler has been trying to eliminate as many
490 typedef definitions in the debugging information, since they generally
491 do not bring any extra information (we still use typedef under certain
492 circumstances related mostly to the GNAT encoding).
493
494 Unfortunately, we have seen situations where the debugging information
495 generated by the compiler leads to such multiple typedef layers. For
496 instance, consider the following example with stabs:
497
498 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:Tt(0,46)=s16P_ARRAY:(0,47)=[...]"[...]
499 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:t(0,36)=(0,46)",128,0,6,0
500
501 This is an error in the debugging information which causes type
502 pck__float_array___XUP to be defined twice, and the second time,
503 it is defined as a typedef of a typedef.
504
505 This is on the fringe of legality as far as debugging information is
506 concerned, and certainly unexpected. But it is easy to handle these
507 situations correctly, so we can afford to be lenient in this case. */
508
509 static struct type *
510 ada_typedef_target_type (struct type *type)
511 {
512 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
513 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
514 return type;
515 }
516
517 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
518 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
519 its unqualified name. */
520
521 static const char *
522 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
523 {
524 const char *result;
525
526 /* If the decoded name starts with '<', it means that the encoded
527 name does not follow standard naming conventions, and thus that
528 it is not your typical Ada symbol name. Trying to unqualify it
529 is therefore pointless and possibly erroneous. */
530 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
531 return decoded_name;
532
533 result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
534 if (result != NULL)
535 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
536 else
537 result = decoded_name;
538
539 return result;
540 }
541
542 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'.
543 The result is good until the next call. */
544
545 static char *
546 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
547 {
548 static char *result = NULL;
549
550 xfree (result);
551 result = xstrprintf ("<%s>", str);
552 return result;
553 }
554
555 static char *
556 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
557 {
558 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
559 }
560
561 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
562
563 static void
564 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream,
565 const struct value_print_options *options)
566 {
567 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options);
568 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
569 }
570
571 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
572 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
573 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
574
575 void *
576 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
577 {
578 if (*size < min_size)
579 {
580 *size *= 2;
581 if (*size < min_size)
582 *size = min_size;
583 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
584 }
585 return vect;
586 }
587
588 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
589 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
590
591 static int
592 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
593 {
594 int len = strlen (target);
595
596 return
597 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
598 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
599 || (startswith (field_name + len, "___")
600 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
601 "___XVN") != 0)));
602 }
603
604
605 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to
606 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME,
607 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name
608 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name
609 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints.
610 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if
611 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
612
613 int
614 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
615 int maybe_missing)
616 {
617 int fieldno;
618 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type);
619
620 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (struct_type); fieldno++)
621 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name))
622 return fieldno;
623
624 if (!maybe_missing)
625 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
626 field_name, TYPE_NAME (struct_type));
627
628 return -1;
629 }
630
631 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
632
633 int
634 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
635 {
636 if (name == NULL)
637 return 0;
638 else
639 {
640 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
641
642 if (p == NULL)
643 return strlen (name);
644 else
645 return p - name;
646 }
647 }
648
649 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
650 Return zero if STR is null. */
651
652 static int
653 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
654 {
655 int len1, len2;
656
657 if (str == NULL)
658 return 0;
659 len1 = strlen (str);
660 len2 = strlen (suffix);
661 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
662 }
663
664 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
665 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
666
667 static struct value *
668 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
669 {
670 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
671 if (value_type (val) == type)
672 return val;
673 else
674 {
675 struct value *result;
676
677 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
678 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
679 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (type);
680
681 if (value_lazy (val)
682 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
683 result = allocate_value_lazy (type);
684 else
685 {
686 result = allocate_value (type);
687 value_contents_copy_raw (result, 0, val, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
688 }
689 set_value_component_location (result, val);
690 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
691 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
692 set_value_address (result, value_address (val));
693 return result;
694 }
695 }
696
697 static const gdb_byte *
698 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
699 {
700 if (valaddr == NULL)
701 return NULL;
702 else
703 return valaddr + offset;
704 }
705
706 static CORE_ADDR
707 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
708 {
709 if (address == 0)
710 return 0;
711 else
712 return address + offset;
713 }
714
715 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
716 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
717 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
718 expression. */
719
720 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
721 provided by "complaint". */
722 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF (1, 2);
723
724 static void
725 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
726 {
727 va_list args;
728
729 va_start (args, format);
730 warnings_issued += 1;
731 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
732 vwarning (format, args);
733
734 va_end (args);
735 }
736
737 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
738 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
739 GDB. */
740
741 void
742 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (const struct type *type)
743 {
744 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
745 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
746 }
747
748 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
749 static LONGEST
750 max_of_size (int size)
751 {
752 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
753
754 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
755 }
756
757 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
758 static LONGEST
759 min_of_size (int size)
760 {
761 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
762 }
763
764 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
765 static ULONGEST
766 umax_of_size (int size)
767 {
768 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
769
770 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
771 }
772
773 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
774 static LONGEST
775 max_of_type (struct type *t)
776 {
777 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
778 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
779 else
780 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
781 }
782
783 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
784 static LONGEST
785 min_of_type (struct type *t)
786 {
787 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
788 return 0;
789 else
790 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
791 }
792
793 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
794 LONGEST
795 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
796 {
797 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, NULL, 0);
798 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
799 {
800 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
801 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type);
802 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
803 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1);
804 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
805 return 1;
806 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
807 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
808 return max_of_type (type);
809 default:
810 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_high_bound."));
811 }
812 }
813
814 /* The smallest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
815 LONGEST
816 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
817 {
818 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, NULL, 0);
819 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
820 {
821 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
822 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type);
823 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
824 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, 0);
825 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
826 return 0;
827 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
828 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
829 return min_of_type (type);
830 default:
831 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_low_bound."));
832 }
833 }
834
835 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
836 non-range scalar type. */
837
838 static struct type *
839 get_base_type (struct type *type)
840 {
841 while (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
842 {
843 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
844 return type;
845 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
846 }
847 return type;
848 }
849
850 /* Return a decoded version of the given VALUE. This means returning
851 a value whose type is obtained by applying all the GNAT-specific
852 encondings, making the resulting type a static but standard description
853 of the initial type. */
854
855 struct value *
856 ada_get_decoded_value (struct value *value)
857 {
858 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (value));
859
860 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)
861 || (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type)
862 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR))
863 {
864 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) /* array access type. */
865 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (value);
866 else
867 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (value);
868 }
869 else
870 value = ada_to_fixed_value (value);
871
872 return value;
873 }
874
875 /* Same as ada_get_decoded_value, but with the given TYPE.
876 Because there is no associated actual value for this type,
877 the resulting type might be a best-effort approximation in
878 the case of dynamic types. */
879
880 struct type *
881 ada_get_decoded_type (struct type *type)
882 {
883 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
884 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
885 type = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (type);
886 return type;
887 }
888
889 \f
890
891 /* Language Selection */
892
893 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
894 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found). */
895
896 enum language
897 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang)
898 {
899 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", (const char *) NULL,
900 (struct objfile *) NULL).minsym != NULL)
901 return language_ada;
902
903 return lang;
904 }
905
906 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
907 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
908 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
909
910 char *
911 ada_main_name (void)
912 {
913 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym;
914 static char *main_program_name = NULL;
915
916 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
917 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
918 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
919 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
920 in Ada. */
921 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
922
923 if (msym.minsym != NULL)
924 {
925 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
926 int err_code;
927
928 main_program_name_addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
929 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
930 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
931
932 xfree (main_program_name);
933 target_read_string (main_program_name_addr, &main_program_name,
934 1024, &err_code);
935
936 if (err_code != 0)
937 return NULL;
938 return main_program_name;
939 }
940
941 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
942 return NULL;
943 }
944 \f
945 /* Symbols */
946
947 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
948 of NULLs. */
949
950 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
951 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
952 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
953 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
954 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
955 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
956 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
957 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
958 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
959 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
960 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
961 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
962 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
963 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
964 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
965 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
966 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
967 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
968 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
969 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
970 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
971 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
972 {NULL, NULL}
973 };
974
975 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
976 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
977
978 char *
979 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
980 {
981 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
982 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
983 const char *p;
984 int k;
985
986 if (decoded == NULL)
987 return NULL;
988
989 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
990 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
991
992 k = 0;
993 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
994 {
995 if (*p == '.')
996 {
997 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
998 k += 2;
999 }
1000 else if (*p == '"')
1001 {
1002 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
1003
1004 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
1005 mapping->encoded != NULL
1006 && !startswith (p, mapping->decoded); mapping += 1)
1007 ;
1008 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
1009 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
1010 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
1011 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
1012 break;
1013 }
1014 else
1015 {
1016 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
1017 k += 1;
1018 }
1019 }
1020
1021 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
1022 return encoding_buffer;
1023 }
1024
1025 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
1026 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
1027 to next call. */
1028
1029 char *
1030 ada_fold_name (const char *name)
1031 {
1032 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
1033 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
1034
1035 int len = strlen (name);
1036 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
1037
1038 if (name[0] == '\'')
1039 {
1040 strncpy (fold_buffer, name + 1, len - 2);
1041 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
1042 }
1043 else
1044 {
1045 int i;
1046
1047 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
1048 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
1049 }
1050
1051 return fold_buffer;
1052 }
1053
1054 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
1055
1056 static int
1057 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
1058 {
1059 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
1060 }
1061
1062 /* ENCODED is the linkage name of a symbol and LEN contains its length.
1063 This function saves in LEN the length of that same symbol name but
1064 without either of these suffixes:
1065 . .{DIGIT}+
1066 . ${DIGIT}+
1067 . ___{DIGIT}+
1068 . __{DIGIT}+.
1069
1070 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
1071 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
1072 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
1073
1074 static void
1075 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
1076 {
1077 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
1078 {
1079 int i = *len - 2;
1080
1081 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1082 i--;
1083 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
1084 *len = i;
1085 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
1086 *len = i;
1087 else if (i >= 2 && startswith (encoded + i - 2, "___"))
1088 *len = i - 2;
1089 else if (i >= 1 && startswith (encoded + i - 1, "__"))
1090 *len = i - 1;
1091 }
1092 }
1093
1094 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
1095 subprograms. */
1096
1097 static void
1098 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
1099 {
1100 /* Remove trailing N. */
1101
1102 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
1103 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
1104 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
1105 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
1106 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
1107 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
1108 entity is internal. */
1109
1110 if (*len > 1
1111 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
1112 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
1113 *len = *len - 1;
1114 }
1115
1116 /* Remove trailing X[bn]* suffixes (indicating names in package bodies). */
1117
1118 static void
1119 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
1120 {
1121 int i = *len - 1;
1122
1123 while (i > 0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'))
1124 i--;
1125
1126 if (encoded[i] != 'X')
1127 return;
1128
1129 if (i == 0)
1130 return;
1131
1132 if (isalnum (encoded[i-1]))
1133 *len = i;
1134 }
1135
1136 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
1137 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
1138 replaced by ENCODED.
1139
1140 The resulting string is valid until the next call of ada_decode.
1141 If the string is unchanged by decoding, the original string pointer
1142 is returned. */
1143
1144 const char *
1145 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
1146 {
1147 int i, j;
1148 int len0;
1149 const char *p;
1150 char *decoded;
1151 int at_start_name;
1152 static char *decoding_buffer = NULL;
1153 static size_t decoding_buffer_size = 0;
1154
1155 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
1156 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
1157 if we see this prefix. */
1158 if (startswith (encoded, "_ada_"))
1159 encoded += 5;
1160
1161 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
1162 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
1163 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
1164 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
1165 goto Suppress;
1166
1167 len0 = strlen (encoded);
1168
1169 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
1170 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
1171
1172 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
1173 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
1174 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
1175 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
1176 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
1177 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
1178 {
1179 if (p[3] == 'X')
1180 len0 = p - encoded;
1181 else
1182 goto Suppress;
1183 }
1184
1185 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
1186 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
1187 appear in the decoded name. */
1188
1189 if (len0 > 3 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB"))
1190 len0 -= 3;
1191
1192 /* Remove any trailing TB suffix. The TB suffix is slightly different
1193 from the TKB suffix because it is used for non-anonymous task
1194 bodies. */
1195
1196 if (len0 > 2 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 2, "TB"))
1197 len0 -= 2;
1198
1199 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
1200 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
1201
1202 if (len0 > 1 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 1, "B"))
1203 len0 -= 1;
1204
1205 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
1206
1207 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, 2 * len0 + 1);
1208 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1209
1210 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
1211
1212 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
1213 {
1214 i = len0 - 2;
1215 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1216 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
1217 i -= 1;
1218 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
1219 len0 = i - 1;
1220 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
1221 len0 = i;
1222 }
1223
1224 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
1225 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
1226
1227 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
1228 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1229
1230 at_start_name = 1;
1231 while (i < len0)
1232 {
1233 /* Is this a symbol function? */
1234 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
1235 {
1236 int k;
1237
1238 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
1239 {
1240 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
1241 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
1242 op_len - 1) == 0)
1243 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
1244 {
1245 strcpy (decoded + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1246 at_start_name = 0;
1247 i += op_len;
1248 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1249 break;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
1253 continue;
1254 }
1255 at_start_name = 0;
1256
1257 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
1258 into "." (just below). */
1259
1260 if (i < len0 - 4 && startswith (encoded + i, "TK__"))
1261 i += 2;
1262
1263 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
1264 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
1265 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
1266
1267 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
1268 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1269 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1270 {
1271 int k = i + 5;
1272
1273 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1274 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1275
1276 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1277 is indeed followed by "__". */
1278 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1279 i = k;
1280 }
1281
1282 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1283
1284 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1285 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1286 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1287 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1288 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1289 by a 'B'.
1290
1291 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1292 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1293 internally generated. */
1294
1295 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1296 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1297 {
1298 int k = i + 3;
1299
1300 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1301 k++;
1302
1303 if (k < len0
1304 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1305 {
1306 k++;
1307 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1308 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1309 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1310 if (k == len0
1311 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1312 i = k;
1313 }
1314 }
1315
1316 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1317 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1318
1319 if (i < len0 + 3
1320 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1321 {
1322 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1323 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1324 digits or lowercase characters. */
1325 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1326
1327 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1328 ptr--;
1329 if (ptr < encoded
1330 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1331 i++;
1332 }
1333
1334 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1335 {
1336 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1337 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1338 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1339 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1340 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1341 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1342 package names. */
1343 do
1344 i += 1;
1345 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1346 if (i < len0)
1347 goto Suppress;
1348 }
1349 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1350 {
1351 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1352 decoded[j] = '.';
1353 at_start_name = 1;
1354 i += 2;
1355 j += 1;
1356 }
1357 else
1358 {
1359 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1360 over. */
1361 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1362 i += 1;
1363 j += 1;
1364 }
1365 }
1366 decoded[j] = '\000';
1367
1368 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1369 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1370
1371 for (i = 0; decoded[i] != '\0'; i += 1)
1372 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1373 goto Suppress;
1374
1375 if (strcmp (decoded, encoded) == 0)
1376 return encoded;
1377 else
1378 return decoded;
1379
1380 Suppress:
1381 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, strlen (encoded) + 3);
1382 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1383 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1384 strcpy (decoded, encoded);
1385 else
1386 xsnprintf (decoded, decoding_buffer_size, "<%s>", encoded);
1387 return decoded;
1388
1389 }
1390
1391 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1392 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1393 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1394 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1395 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1396 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1397
1398 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1399 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1400 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1401 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1402 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1403 GSYMBOL).
1404 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1405 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1406 when a decoded name is cached in it. */
1407
1408 const char *
1409 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *arg)
1410 {
1411 struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol = (struct general_symbol_info *) arg;
1412 const char **resultp =
1413 &gsymbol->language_specific.mangled_lang.demangled_name;
1414
1415 if (!gsymbol->ada_mangled)
1416 {
1417 const char *decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->name);
1418 struct obstack *obstack = gsymbol->language_specific.obstack;
1419
1420 gsymbol->ada_mangled = 1;
1421
1422 if (obstack != NULL)
1423 *resultp = obstack_copy0 (obstack, decoded, strlen (decoded));
1424 else
1425 {
1426 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in
1427 which case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only
1428 decode when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1429 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1430
1431 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1432 decoded, INSERT);
1433
1434 if (*slot == NULL)
1435 *slot = xstrdup (decoded);
1436 *resultp = *slot;
1437 }
1438 }
1439
1440 return *resultp;
1441 }
1442
1443 static char *
1444 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1445 {
1446 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded));
1447 }
1448
1449 /* Returns non-zero iff SYM_NAME matches NAME, ignoring any trailing
1450 suffixes that encode debugging information or leading _ada_ on
1451 SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
1452 information that is ignored). If WILD, then NAME need only match a
1453 suffix of SYM_NAME minus the same suffixes. Also returns 0 if
1454 either argument is NULL. */
1455
1456 static int
1457 match_name (const char *sym_name, const char *name, int wild)
1458 {
1459 if (sym_name == NULL || name == NULL)
1460 return 0;
1461 else if (wild)
1462 return wild_match (sym_name, name) == 0;
1463 else
1464 {
1465 int len_name = strlen (name);
1466
1467 return (strncmp (sym_name, name, len_name) == 0
1468 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name))
1469 || (startswith (sym_name, "_ada_")
1470 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, name, len_name) == 0
1471 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name + 5));
1472 }
1473 }
1474 \f
1475
1476 /* Arrays */
1477
1478 /* Assuming that INDEX_DESC_TYPE is an ___XA structure, a structure
1479 generated by the GNAT compiler to describe the index type used
1480 for each dimension of an array, check whether it follows the latest
1481 known encoding. If not, fix it up to conform to the latest encoding.
1482 Otherwise, do nothing. This function also does nothing if
1483 INDEX_DESC_TYPE is NULL.
1484
1485 The GNAT encoding used to describle the array index type evolved a bit.
1486 Initially, the information would be provided through the name of each
1487 field of the structure type only, while the type of these fields was
1488 described as unspecified and irrelevant. The debugger was then expected
1489 to perform a global type lookup using the name of that field in order
1490 to get access to the full index type description. Because these global
1491 lookups can be very expensive, the encoding was later enhanced to make
1492 the global lookup unnecessary by defining the field type as being
1493 the full index type description.
1494
1495 The purpose of this routine is to allow us to support older versions
1496 of the compiler by detecting the use of the older encoding, and by
1497 fixing up the INDEX_DESC_TYPE to follow the new one (at this point,
1498 we essentially replace each field's meaningless type by the associated
1499 index subtype). */
1500
1501 void
1502 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (struct type *index_desc_type)
1503 {
1504 int i;
1505
1506 if (index_desc_type == NULL)
1507 return;
1508 gdb_assert (TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type) > 0);
1509
1510 /* Check if INDEX_DESC_TYPE follows the older encoding (it is sufficient
1511 to check one field only, no need to check them all). If not, return
1512 now.
1513
1514 If our INDEX_DESC_TYPE was generated using the older encoding,
1515 the field type should be a meaningless integer type whose name
1516 is not equal to the field name. */
1517 if (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)) != NULL
1518 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)),
1519 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, 0)) == 0)
1520 return;
1521
1522 /* Fixup each field of INDEX_DESC_TYPE. */
1523 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type); i++)
1524 {
1525 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, i);
1526 struct type *raw_type = ada_check_typedef (ada_find_any_type (name));
1527
1528 if (raw_type)
1529 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, i) = raw_type;
1530 }
1531 }
1532
1533 /* Names of MAX_ADA_DIMENS bounds in P_BOUNDS fields of array descriptors. */
1534
1535 static char *bound_name[] = {
1536 "LB0", "UB0", "LB1", "UB1", "LB2", "UB2", "LB3", "UB3",
1537 "LB4", "UB4", "LB5", "UB5", "LB6", "UB6", "LB7", "UB7"
1538 };
1539
1540 /* Maximum number of array dimensions we are prepared to handle. */
1541
1542 #define MAX_ADA_DIMENS (sizeof(bound_name) / (2*sizeof(char *)))
1543
1544
1545 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1546 (fat pointers). */
1547
1548 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1549 level of indirection, if needed. */
1550
1551 static struct type *
1552 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1553 {
1554 if (type == NULL)
1555 return NULL;
1556 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1557 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
1558 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
1559
1560 if (type != NULL
1561 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1562 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1563 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1564 else
1565 return type;
1566 }
1567
1568 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1569
1570 static int
1571 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1572 {
1573 return
1574 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1575 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1576 }
1577
1578 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1579
1580 static struct type *
1581 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1582 {
1583 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1584
1585 if (base_type == NULL)
1586 return NULL;
1587 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1588 return base_type;
1589 else
1590 {
1591 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1592
1593 if (alt_type == NULL)
1594 return base_type;
1595 else
1596 return alt_type;
1597 }
1598 }
1599
1600 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1601
1602 static struct value *
1603 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1604 {
1605 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
1606 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1607
1608 data_type = lookup_pointer_type (data_type);
1609
1610 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1611 return value_cast (data_type, value_copy (val));
1612 else
1613 return value_from_longest (data_type, value_address (val));
1614 }
1615
1616 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1617
1618 static int
1619 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1620 {
1621 type = desc_base_type (type);
1622 return (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1623 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1624 }
1625
1626 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1627 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1628
1629 static struct type *
1630 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1631 {
1632 struct type *r;
1633
1634 type = desc_base_type (type);
1635
1636 if (type == NULL)
1637 return NULL;
1638 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1639 {
1640 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1641 if (type == NULL)
1642 return NULL;
1643 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1644 if (r != NULL)
1645 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1646 }
1647 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1648 {
1649 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1650 if (r != NULL)
1651 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1652 }
1653 return NULL;
1654 }
1655
1656 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1657 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1658
1659 static struct value *
1660 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1661 {
1662 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1663
1664 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1665 {
1666 struct type *bounds_type =
1667 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1668 LONGEST addr;
1669
1670 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1671 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1672
1673 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1674 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1675 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1676 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1677 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1678 else
1679 addr = value_address (arr);
1680
1681 return
1682 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1683 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1684 }
1685
1686 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1687 {
1688 struct value *p_bounds = value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1689 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1690 struct type *p_bounds_type = value_type (p_bounds);
1691
1692 if (p_bounds_type
1693 && TYPE_CODE (p_bounds_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1694 {
1695 struct type *target_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_bounds_type);
1696
1697 if (TYPE_STUB (target_type))
1698 p_bounds = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type
1699 (ada_check_typedef (target_type)),
1700 p_bounds);
1701 }
1702 else
1703 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1704
1705 return p_bounds;
1706 }
1707 else
1708 return NULL;
1709 }
1710
1711 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1712 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1713
1714 static int
1715 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1716 {
1717 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1718 }
1719
1720 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1721 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1722
1723 static int
1724 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1725 {
1726 type = desc_base_type (type);
1727
1728 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1729 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1730 else
1731 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1732 }
1733
1734 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1735 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a array-with-no-bounds type);
1736 otherwise, NULL. Use ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds
1737 data. */
1738
1739 static struct type *
1740 desc_data_target_type (struct type *type)
1741 {
1742 type = desc_base_type (type);
1743
1744 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1745 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1746 return desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1));
1747 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1748 {
1749 struct type *data_type = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1750
1751 if (data_type
1752 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (data_type)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1753 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type));
1754 }
1755
1756 return NULL;
1757 }
1758
1759 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1760 its array data. */
1761
1762 static struct value *
1763 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1764 {
1765 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1766
1767 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1768 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1769 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1770 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1771 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1772 else
1773 return NULL;
1774 }
1775
1776
1777 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1778 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1779
1780 static int
1781 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1782 {
1783 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1784 }
1785
1786 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1787 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1788
1789 static int
1790 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1791 {
1792 type = desc_base_type (type);
1793
1794 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1795 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1796 else
1797 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1798 }
1799
1800 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1801 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1802 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1803
1804 static struct value *
1805 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1806 {
1807 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name[2 * i + which - 2], NULL,
1808 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1809 }
1810
1811 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1812 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1813 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1814
1815 static int
1816 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1817 {
1818 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1819 }
1820
1821 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1822 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1823 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1824
1825 static int
1826 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1827 {
1828 type = desc_base_type (type);
1829
1830 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1831 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1832 else
1833 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1834 }
1835
1836 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1837 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1838
1839 static struct type *
1840 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1841 {
1842 type = desc_base_type (type);
1843
1844 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1845 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name[2 * i - 2], 1);
1846 else
1847 return NULL;
1848 }
1849
1850 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1851 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1852
1853 static int
1854 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1855 {
1856 type = desc_base_type (type);
1857
1858 if (type != NULL)
1859 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2;
1860 return 0;
1861 }
1862
1863 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1864 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1865 type). */
1866
1867 static int
1868 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1869 {
1870 if (type == NULL)
1871 return 0;
1872 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1873 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1874 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1875 }
1876
1877 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1878 * to one. */
1879
1880 static int
1881 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1882 {
1883 while (type != NULL
1884 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1885 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1886 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1887 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1888 }
1889
1890 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1891
1892 int
1893 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1894 {
1895 if (type == NULL)
1896 return 0;
1897 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1898 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1899 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1900 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
1901 == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY));
1902 }
1903
1904 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1905
1906 int
1907 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1908 {
1909 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
1910
1911 if (type == NULL)
1912 return 0;
1913 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1914 return (data_type != NULL
1915 && TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1916 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0);
1917 }
1918
1919 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1920 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1921 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1922 is still needed. */
1923
1924 int
1925 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1926 {
1927 return
1928 type != NULL
1929 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1930 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1931 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1932 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1933 }
1934
1935
1936 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1937 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1938 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1939 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1940 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1941 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1942 a descriptor. */
1943 struct type *
1944 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1945 {
1946 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1947 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1948
1949 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1950 return value_type (arr);
1951
1952 if (!bounds)
1953 {
1954 struct type *array_type =
1955 ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (value_type (arr)));
1956
1957 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1958 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (array_type, 0) =
1959 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1960
1961 return array_type;
1962 }
1963 else
1964 {
1965 struct type *elt_type;
1966 int arity;
1967 struct value *descriptor;
1968
1969 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1970 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1971
1972 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1973 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1974
1975 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1976 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1977 return NULL;
1978 while (arity > 0)
1979 {
1980 struct type *range_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1981 struct type *array_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1982 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1983 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1984
1985 arity -= 1;
1986 create_static_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1987 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1988 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1989 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1990
1991 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1992 {
1993 /* We need to store the element packed bitsize, as well as
1994 recompute the array size, because it was previously
1995 computed based on the unpacked element size. */
1996 LONGEST lo = value_as_long (low);
1997 LONGEST hi = value_as_long (high);
1998
1999 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) =
2000 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
2001 /* If the array has no element, then the size is already
2002 zero, and does not need to be recomputed. */
2003 if (lo < hi)
2004 {
2005 int array_bitsize =
2006 (hi - lo + 1) * TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
2007
2008 TYPE_LENGTH (array_type) = (array_bitsize + 7) / 8;
2009 }
2010 }
2011 }
2012
2013 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
2014 }
2015 }
2016
2017 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
2018 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
2019 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
2020 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
2021
2022 struct value *
2023 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
2024 {
2025 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
2026 {
2027 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
2028
2029 if (arrType == NULL)
2030 return NULL;
2031 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
2032 }
2033 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
2034 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
2035 else
2036 return arr;
2037 }
2038
2039 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
2040 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
2041 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
2042
2043 struct value *
2044 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
2045 {
2046 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
2047 {
2048 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
2049
2050 if (arrVal == NULL)
2051 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
2052 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
2053 return value_ind (arrVal);
2054 }
2055 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
2056 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
2057 else
2058 return arr;
2059 }
2060
2061 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
2062 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
2063 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
2064
2065 struct type *
2066 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
2067 {
2068 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
2069 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type);
2070
2071 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
2072 return ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (type));
2073
2074 return type;
2075 }
2076
2077 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
2078
2079 static int
2080 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2081 {
2082 if (type == NULL)
2083 return 0;
2084 type = desc_base_type (type);
2085 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2086 return
2087 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
2088 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
2089 }
2090
2091 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT constrained
2092 packed-array type. */
2093
2094 int
2095 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2096 {
2097 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
2098 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2099 }
2100
2101 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents an array descriptor for a
2102 unconstrained packed-array type. */
2103
2104 static int
2105 ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2106 {
2107 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
2108 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2109 }
2110
2111 /* Given that TYPE encodes a packed array type (constrained or unconstrained),
2112 return the size of its elements in bits. */
2113
2114 static long
2115 decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *type)
2116 {
2117 const char *raw_name;
2118 const char *tail;
2119 long bits;
2120
2121 /* Access to arrays implemented as fat pointers are encoded as a typedef
2122 of the fat pointer type. We need the name of the fat pointer type
2123 to do the decoding, so strip the typedef layer. */
2124 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
2125 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
2126
2127 raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2128 if (!raw_name)
2129 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2130
2131 if (!raw_name)
2132 return 0;
2133
2134 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2135 gdb_assert (tail != NULL);
2136
2137 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
2138 {
2139 lim_warning
2140 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
2141 return 0;
2142 }
2143
2144 return bits;
2145 }
2146
2147 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
2148 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
2149 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
2150 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
2151 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
2152 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
2153 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
2154 in bits.
2155
2156 Note that, for arrays whose index type has an XA encoding where
2157 a bound references a record discriminant, getting that discriminant,
2158 and therefore the actual value of that bound, is not possible
2159 because none of the given parameters gives us access to the record.
2160 This function assumes that it is OK in the context where it is being
2161 used to return an array whose bounds are still dynamic and where
2162 the length is arbitrary. */
2163
2164 static struct type *
2165 constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
2166 {
2167 struct type *new_elt_type;
2168 struct type *new_type;
2169 struct type *index_type_desc;
2170 struct type *index_type;
2171 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
2172
2173 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2174 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2175 return type;
2176
2177 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2178 if (index_type_desc)
2179 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, 0),
2180 NULL);
2181 else
2182 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type);
2183
2184 new_type = alloc_type_copy (type);
2185 new_elt_type =
2186 constrained_packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2187 elt_bits);
2188 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, index_type);
2189 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
2190 TYPE_NAME (new_type) = ada_type_name (type);
2191
2192 if ((TYPE_CODE (check_typedef (index_type)) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
2193 && is_dynamic_type (check_typedef (index_type)))
2194 || get_discrete_bounds (index_type, &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
2195 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
2196 if (high_bound < low_bound)
2197 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
2198 else
2199 {
2200 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
2201 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
2202 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2203 }
2204
2205 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1;
2206 return new_type;
2207 }
2208
2209 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where
2210 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
2211
2212 static struct type *
2213 decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2214 {
2215 const char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2216 char *name;
2217 const char *tail;
2218 struct type *shadow_type;
2219 long bits;
2220
2221 if (!raw_name)
2222 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2223
2224 if (!raw_name)
2225 return NULL;
2226
2227 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
2228 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2229 type = desc_base_type (type);
2230
2231 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
2232 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
2233
2234 shadow_type = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
2235
2236 if (shadow_type == NULL)
2237 {
2238 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
2239 return NULL;
2240 }
2241 CHECK_TYPEDEF (shadow_type);
2242
2243 if (TYPE_CODE (shadow_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2244 {
2245 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds "
2246 "information on packed array"));
2247 return NULL;
2248 }
2249
2250 bits = decode_packed_array_bitsize (type);
2251 return constrained_packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
2252 }
2253
2254 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT constrained packed
2255 array, returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
2256 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
2257 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
2258 type length is set appropriately. */
2259
2260 static struct value *
2261 decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *arr)
2262 {
2263 struct type *type;
2264
2265 /* If our value is a pointer, then dereference it. Likewise if
2266 the value is a reference. Make sure that this operation does not
2267 cause the target type to be fixed, as this would indirectly cause
2268 this array to be decoded. The rest of the routine assumes that
2269 the array hasn't been decoded yet, so we use the basic "coerce_ref"
2270 and "value_ind" routines to perform the dereferencing, as opposed
2271 to using "ada_coerce_ref" or "ada_value_ind". */
2272 arr = coerce_ref (arr);
2273 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2274 arr = value_ind (arr);
2275
2276 type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
2277 if (type == NULL)
2278 {
2279 error (_("can't unpack array"));
2280 return NULL;
2281 }
2282
2283 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (arr)))
2284 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
2285 {
2286 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
2287 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
2288 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
2289 first left-justify it. */
2290 int bit_size, bit_pos;
2291 ULONGEST mod;
2292
2293 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
2294 bit_size = 0;
2295 while (mod > 0)
2296 {
2297 bit_size += 1;
2298 mod >>= 1;
2299 }
2300 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
2301 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
2302 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2303 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2304 bit_size,
2305 type);
2306 }
2307
2308 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
2309 }
2310
2311
2312 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
2313 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
2314
2315 static struct value *
2316 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2317 {
2318 int i;
2319 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
2320 long elt_total_bit_offset;
2321 struct type *elt_type;
2322 struct value *v;
2323
2324 bits = 0;
2325 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
2326 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2327 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
2328 {
2329 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2330 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
2331 error
2332 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of "
2333 "something other than a packed array"));
2334 else
2335 {
2336 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2337 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
2338 LONGEST idx;
2339
2340 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
2341 {
2342 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
2343 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
2344 }
2345
2346 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]);
2347 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
2348 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"),
2349 (long) idx);
2350 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
2351 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
2352 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
2353 }
2354 }
2355 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2356 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2357
2358 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
2359 bits, elt_type);
2360 return v;
2361 }
2362
2363 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
2364
2365 static int
2366 has_negatives (struct type *type)
2367 {
2368 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2369 {
2370 default:
2371 return 0;
2372 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
2373 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
2374 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2375 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) < 0;
2376 }
2377 }
2378
2379
2380 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
2381 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
2382 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
2383 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
2384 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
2385 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
2386 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
2387 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
2388
2389 struct value *
2390 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
2391 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2392 struct type *type)
2393 {
2394 struct value *v;
2395 int src, /* Index into the source area */
2396 targ, /* Index into the target area */
2397 srcBitsLeft, /* Number of source bits left to move */
2398 nsrc, ntarg, /* Number of source and target bytes */
2399 unusedLS, /* Number of bits in next significant
2400 byte of source that are unused */
2401 accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
2402 unsigned char *bytes; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
2403 unsigned char *unpacked;
2404 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
2405 unsigned char sign;
2406 int len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2407 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
2408 the indices move. */
2409 int delta = gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)) ? -1 : 1;
2410
2411 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2412
2413 if (obj == NULL)
2414 {
2415 v = allocate_value (type);
2416 bytes = (unsigned char *) (valaddr + offset);
2417 }
2418 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
2419 {
2420 v = value_at (type, value_address (obj) + offset);
2421 type = value_type (v);
2422 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < bit_size)
2423 {
2424 /* This can happen in the case of an array of dynamic objects,
2425 where the size of each element changes from element to element.
2426 In that case, we're initially given the array stride, but
2427 after resolving the element type, we find that its size is
2428 less than this stride. In that case, adjust bit_size to
2429 match TYPE's length, and recompute LEN accordingly. */
2430 bit_size = TYPE_LENGTH (type) * HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2431 len = TYPE_LENGTH (type) + (bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2432 }
2433 bytes = (unsigned char *) alloca (len);
2434 read_memory (value_address (v), bytes, len);
2435 }
2436 else
2437 {
2438 v = allocate_value (type);
2439 bytes = (unsigned char *) value_contents (obj) + offset;
2440 }
2441
2442 if (obj != NULL)
2443 {
2444 long new_offset = offset;
2445
2446 set_value_component_location (v, obj);
2447 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
2448 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2449 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2450 {
2451 ++new_offset;
2452 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2453 }
2454 set_value_offset (v, new_offset);
2455
2456 /* Also set the parent value. This is needed when trying to
2457 assign a new value (in inferior memory). */
2458 set_value_parent (v, obj);
2459 }
2460 else
2461 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2462 unpacked = (unsigned char *) value_contents (v);
2463
2464 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
2465 nsrc = len;
2466 ntarg = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
2467 sign = 0;
2468 if (bit_size == 0)
2469 {
2470 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2471 return v;
2472 }
2473 else if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2474 {
2475 src = len - 1;
2476 if (has_negatives (type)
2477 && ((bytes[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2478 sign = ~0;
2479
2480 unusedLS =
2481 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2482 % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2483
2484 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2485 {
2486 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
2487 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
2488 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
2489 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2490 accumSize =
2491 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2492 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2493 of the target. */
2494 targ = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2495 ntarg = targ + 1;
2496 break;
2497 default:
2498 accumSize = 0;
2499 targ = TYPE_LENGTH (type) - 1;
2500 break;
2501 }
2502 }
2503 else
2504 {
2505 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2506
2507 src = targ = 0;
2508 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2509 accumSize = 0;
2510
2511 if (has_negatives (type) && (bytes[len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2512 sign = ~0;
2513 }
2514
2515 accum = 0;
2516 while (nsrc > 0)
2517 {
2518 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2519 part of the value. */
2520 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2521 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2522 1;
2523 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2524 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2525
2526 accum |=
2527 (((bytes[src] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2528 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2529 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2530 {
2531 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2532 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2533 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2534 ntarg -= 1;
2535 targ += delta;
2536 }
2537 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2538 unusedLS = 0;
2539 nsrc -= 1;
2540 src += delta;
2541 }
2542 while (ntarg > 0)
2543 {
2544 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2545 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2546 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2547 if (accumSize < 0)
2548 accumSize = 0;
2549 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2550 ntarg -= 1;
2551 targ += delta;
2552 }
2553
2554 if (is_dynamic_type (value_type (v)))
2555 v = value_from_contents_and_address (value_type (v), value_contents (v),
2556 0);
2557 return v;
2558 }
2559
2560 /* Move N bits from SOURCE, starting at bit offset SRC_OFFSET to
2561 TARGET, starting at bit offset TARG_OFFSET. SOURCE and TARGET must
2562 not overlap. */
2563 static void
2564 move_bits (gdb_byte *target, int targ_offset, const gdb_byte *source,
2565 int src_offset, int n, int bits_big_endian_p)
2566 {
2567 unsigned int accum, mask;
2568 int accum_bits, chunk_size;
2569
2570 target += targ_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2571 targ_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2572 source += src_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2573 src_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2574 if (bits_big_endian_p)
2575 {
2576 accum = (unsigned char) *source;
2577 source += 1;
2578 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2579
2580 while (n > 0)
2581 {
2582 int unused_right;
2583
2584 accum = (accum << HOST_CHAR_BIT) + (unsigned char) *source;
2585 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2586 source += 1;
2587 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2588 if (chunk_size > n)
2589 chunk_size = n;
2590 unused_right = HOST_CHAR_BIT - (chunk_size + targ_offset);
2591 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << unused_right;
2592 *target =
2593 (*target & ~mask)
2594 | ((accum >> (accum_bits - chunk_size - unused_right)) & mask);
2595 n -= chunk_size;
2596 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2597 target += 1;
2598 targ_offset = 0;
2599 }
2600 }
2601 else
2602 {
2603 accum = (unsigned char) *source >> src_offset;
2604 source += 1;
2605 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2606
2607 while (n > 0)
2608 {
2609 accum = accum + ((unsigned char) *source << accum_bits);
2610 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2611 source += 1;
2612 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2613 if (chunk_size > n)
2614 chunk_size = n;
2615 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << targ_offset;
2616 *target = (*target & ~mask) | ((accum << targ_offset) & mask);
2617 n -= chunk_size;
2618 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2619 accum >>= chunk_size;
2620 target += 1;
2621 targ_offset = 0;
2622 }
2623 }
2624 }
2625
2626 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2627 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2628 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2629 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2630
2631 static struct value *
2632 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2633 {
2634 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2635 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2636
2637 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2638 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2639
2640 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2641 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2642 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2643 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2644
2645 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2646 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2647
2648 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2649 && bits > 0
2650 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2651 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2652 {
2653 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2654 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2655 int from_size;
2656 gdb_byte *buffer = alloca (len);
2657 struct value *val;
2658 CORE_ADDR to_addr = value_address (toval);
2659
2660 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2661 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2662
2663 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2664 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval);
2665 if (from_size == 0)
2666 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
2667 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2668 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2669 value_contents (fromval), from_size - bits, bits, 1);
2670 else
2671 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2672 value_contents (fromval), 0, bits, 0);
2673 write_memory_with_notification (to_addr, buffer, len);
2674
2675 val = value_copy (toval);
2676 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2677 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2678 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2679
2680 return val;
2681 }
2682
2683 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2684 }
2685
2686
2687 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2688 CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2689 CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2690 COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2691 of COMPONENT are ignored.
2692
2693 Although not part of the initial design, this function also works
2694 when CONTAINER and COMPONENT are not_lval's: it works as if CONTAINER
2695 had a null address, and COMPONENT had an address which is equal to
2696 its offset inside CONTAINER. */
2697
2698 static void
2699 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2700 struct value *val)
2701 {
2702 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2703 (LONGEST) (value_address (component) - value_address (container));
2704 int bit_offset_in_container =
2705 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2706 int bits;
2707
2708 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2709
2710 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2711 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2712 else
2713 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2714
2715 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (container))))
2716 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2717 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2718 value_contents (val),
2719 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits,
2720 bits, 1);
2721 else
2722 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2723 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2724 value_contents (val), 0, bits, 0);
2725 }
2726
2727 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2728 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2729 thereto. */
2730
2731 struct value *
2732 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2733 {
2734 int k;
2735 struct value *elt;
2736 struct type *elt_type;
2737
2738 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2739
2740 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2741 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2742 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2743 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2744
2745 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2746 {
2747 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2748 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2749 elt = value_subscript (elt, pos_atr (ind[k]));
2750 }
2751 return elt;
2752 }
2753
2754 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a GDB array, the value of the element
2755 of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2756 Does not read the entire array into memory. */
2757
2758 static struct value *
2759 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2760 {
2761 int k;
2762 struct type *type
2763 = check_typedef (value_enclosing_type (ada_value_ind (arr)));
2764
2765 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2766 {
2767 LONGEST lwb, upb;
2768 struct value *lwb_value;
2769
2770 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2771 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2772 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2773 value_copy (arr));
2774 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2775 lwb_value = value_from_longest (value_type(ind[k]), lwb);
2776 arr = value_ptradd (arr, pos_atr (ind[k]) - pos_atr (lwb_value));
2777 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2778 }
2779
2780 return value_ind (arr);
2781 }
2782
2783 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2784 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of
2785 HIGH'Pos-LOW'Pos+1 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of
2786 this array is LOW, as per Ada rules. */
2787 static struct value *
2788 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2789 int low, int high)
2790 {
2791 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (type);
2792 struct type *base_index_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
2793 struct type *index_type
2794 = create_static_range_type (NULL, base_index_type, low, high);
2795 struct type *slice_type =
2796 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), index_type);
2797 int base_low = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
2798 LONGEST base_low_pos, low_pos;
2799 CORE_ADDR base;
2800
2801 if (!discrete_position (base_index_type, low, &low_pos)
2802 || !discrete_position (base_index_type, base_low, &base_low_pos))
2803 {
2804 warning (_("unable to get positions in slice, use bounds instead"));
2805 low_pos = low;
2806 base_low_pos = base_low;
2807 }
2808
2809 base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2810 + ((low_pos - base_low_pos)
2811 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0)));
2812 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base);
2813 }
2814
2815
2816 static struct value *
2817 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2818 {
2819 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
2820 struct type *base_index_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2821 struct type *index_type
2822 = create_static_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2823 struct type *slice_type =
2824 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2825 LONGEST low_pos, high_pos;
2826
2827 if (!discrete_position (base_index_type, low, &low_pos)
2828 || !discrete_position (base_index_type, high, &high_pos))
2829 {
2830 warning (_("unable to get positions in slice, use bounds instead"));
2831 low_pos = low;
2832 high_pos = high;
2833 }
2834
2835 return value_cast (slice_type,
2836 value_slice (array, low, high_pos - low_pos + 1));
2837 }
2838
2839 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2840 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2841 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2842 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2843
2844 int
2845 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2846 {
2847 int arity;
2848
2849 if (type == NULL)
2850 return 0;
2851
2852 type = desc_base_type (type);
2853
2854 arity = 0;
2855 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2856 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2857 else
2858 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2859 {
2860 arity += 1;
2861 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2862 }
2863
2864 return arity;
2865 }
2866
2867 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2868 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2869 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2870 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2871
2872 struct type *
2873 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2874 {
2875 type = desc_base_type (type);
2876
2877 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2878 {
2879 int k;
2880 struct type *p_array_type;
2881
2882 p_array_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
2883
2884 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2885 if (k == 0)
2886 return NULL;
2887
2888 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2889 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2890 k = nindices;
2891 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2892 {
2893 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2894 k -= 1;
2895 }
2896 return p_array_type;
2897 }
2898 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2899 {
2900 while (nindices != 0 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2901 {
2902 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2903 nindices -= 1;
2904 }
2905 return type;
2906 }
2907
2908 return NULL;
2909 }
2910
2911 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2912 Does not examine memory. Throws an error if N is invalid or TYPE
2913 is not an array type. NAME is the name of the Ada attribute being
2914 evaluated ('range, 'first, 'last, or 'length); it is used in building
2915 the error message. */
2916
2917 static struct type *
2918 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n, const char *name)
2919 {
2920 struct type *result_type;
2921
2922 type = desc_base_type (type);
2923
2924 if (n < 0 || n > ada_array_arity (type))
2925 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"), name);
2926
2927 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2928 {
2929 int i;
2930
2931 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2932 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2933 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2934 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2935 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2936 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2937 if (result_type && TYPE_CODE (result_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2938 result_type = NULL;
2939 }
2940 else
2941 {
2942 result_type = desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2943 if (result_type == NULL)
2944 error (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
2945 }
2946
2947 return result_type;
2948 }
2949
2950 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2951 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2952 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2953 array-descriptor type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied
2954 by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2955
2956 static LONGEST
2957 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type *arr_type, int n, int which)
2958 {
2959 struct type *type, *index_type_desc, *index_type;
2960 int i;
2961
2962 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1);
2963
2964 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2965 arr_type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2966
2967 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2968 return (LONGEST) - which;
2969
2970 if (TYPE_CODE (arr_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2971 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2972 else
2973 type = arr_type;
2974
2975 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type))
2976 {
2977 /* The array has already been fixed, so we do not need to
2978 check the parallel ___XA type again. That encoding has
2979 already been applied, so ignore it now. */
2980 index_type_desc = NULL;
2981 }
2982 else
2983 {
2984 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2985 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
2986 }
2987
2988 if (index_type_desc != NULL)
2989 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, n - 1),
2990 NULL);
2991 else
2992 {
2993 struct type *elt_type = check_typedef (type);
2994
2995 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
2996 elt_type = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
2997
2998 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2999 }
3000
3001 return
3002 (LONGEST) (which == 0
3003 ? ada_discrete_type_low_bound (index_type)
3004 : ada_discrete_type_high_bound (index_type));
3005 }
3006
3007 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
3008 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
3009 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
3010 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
3011
3012 static LONGEST
3013 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
3014 {
3015 struct type *arr_type;
3016
3017 if (TYPE_CODE (check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3018 arr = value_ind (arr);
3019 arr_type = value_enclosing_type (arr);
3020
3021 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
3022 return ada_array_bound (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n, which);
3023 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
3024 return ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which);
3025 else
3026 return value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which));
3027 }
3028
3029 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
3030 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
3031 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
3032 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
3033 clauses at the moment. */
3034
3035 static LONGEST
3036 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
3037 {
3038 struct type *arr_type, *index_type;
3039 int low, high;
3040
3041 if (TYPE_CODE (check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3042 arr = value_ind (arr);
3043 arr_type = value_enclosing_type (arr);
3044
3045 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
3046 return ada_array_length (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n);
3047
3048 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
3049 {
3050 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0);
3051 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1);
3052 }
3053 else
3054 {
3055 low = value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 0));
3056 high = value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 1));
3057 }
3058
3059 CHECK_TYPEDEF (arr_type);
3060 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type);
3061 if (index_type != NULL)
3062 {
3063 struct type *base_type;
3064 if (TYPE_CODE (index_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
3065 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (index_type);
3066 else
3067 base_type = index_type;
3068
3069 low = pos_atr (value_from_longest (base_type, low));
3070 high = pos_atr (value_from_longest (base_type, high));
3071 }
3072 return high - low + 1;
3073 }
3074
3075 /* An empty array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type),
3076 with bounds LOW to LOW-1. */
3077
3078 static struct value *
3079 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low)
3080 {
3081 struct type *arr_type0 = ada_check_typedef (arr_type);
3082 struct type *index_type
3083 = create_static_range_type
3084 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type0)), low, low - 1);
3085 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type0, 1);
3086
3087 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
3088 }
3089 \f
3090
3091 /* Name resolution */
3092
3093 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
3094 to OP. */
3095
3096 static const char *
3097 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
3098 {
3099 int i;
3100
3101 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
3102 {
3103 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
3104 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
3105 }
3106 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
3107 }
3108
3109
3110 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
3111 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
3112 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
3113 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
3114 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
3115 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
3116 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
3117 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
3118
3119 static void
3120 resolve (struct expression **expp, int void_context_p)
3121 {
3122 struct type *context_type = NULL;
3123 int pc = 0;
3124
3125 if (void_context_p)
3126 context_type = builtin_type ((*expp)->gdbarch)->builtin_void;
3127
3128 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, context_type);
3129 }
3130
3131 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
3132 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
3133 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
3134 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
3135 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
3136 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
3137 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
3138 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
3139
3140 static struct value *
3141 resolve_subexp (struct expression **expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
3142 struct type *context_type)
3143 {
3144 int pc = *pos;
3145 int i;
3146 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
3147 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
3148 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
3149 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
3150 int oplen;
3151
3152 argvec = NULL;
3153 nargs = 0;
3154 exp = *expp;
3155
3156 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
3157 if needed. */
3158 switch (op)
3159 {
3160 case OP_FUNCALL:
3161 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3162 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3163 *pos += 7;
3164 else
3165 {
3166 *pos += 3;
3167 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
3168 }
3169 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
3170 break;
3171
3172 case UNOP_ADDR:
3173 *pos += 1;
3174 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
3175 break;
3176
3177 case UNOP_QUAL:
3178 *pos += 3;
3179 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type));
3180 break;
3181
3182 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
3183 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
3184 case OP_ATR_TAG:
3185 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
3186 case OP_ATR_LAST:
3187 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
3188 case OP_ATR_POS:
3189 case OP_ATR_VAL:
3190 case OP_ATR_MIN:
3191 case OP_ATR_MAX:
3192 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
3193 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
3194 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
3195 case OP_AGGREGATE:
3196 case OP_OTHERS:
3197 case OP_CHOICES:
3198 case OP_POSITIONAL:
3199 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
3200 case OP_NAME:
3201 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
3202 *pos += oplen;
3203 break;
3204
3205 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
3206 {
3207 struct value *arg1;
3208
3209 *pos += 1;
3210 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
3211 if (arg1 == NULL)
3212 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
3213 else
3214 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1));
3215 break;
3216 }
3217
3218 case UNOP_CAST:
3219 *pos += 3;
3220 nargs = 1;
3221 break;
3222
3223 case BINOP_ADD:
3224 case BINOP_SUB:
3225 case BINOP_MUL:
3226 case BINOP_DIV:
3227 case BINOP_REM:
3228 case BINOP_MOD:
3229 case BINOP_EXP:
3230 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3231 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
3232 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
3233 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3234 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3235 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3236
3237 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3238 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3239 case BINOP_LESS:
3240 case BINOP_GTR:
3241 case BINOP_LEQ:
3242 case BINOP_GEQ:
3243
3244 case BINOP_REPEAT:
3245 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
3246 case BINOP_COMMA:
3247 *pos += 1;
3248 nargs = 2;
3249 break;
3250
3251 case UNOP_NEG:
3252 case UNOP_PLUS:
3253 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3254 case UNOP_ABS:
3255 case UNOP_IND:
3256 *pos += 1;
3257 nargs = 1;
3258 break;
3259
3260 case OP_LONG:
3261 case OP_DOUBLE:
3262 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3263 *pos += 4;
3264 break;
3265
3266 case OP_TYPE:
3267 case OP_BOOL:
3268 case OP_LAST:
3269 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
3270 *pos += 3;
3271 break;
3272
3273 case UNOP_MEMVAL:
3274 *pos += 3;
3275 nargs = 1;
3276 break;
3277
3278 case OP_REGISTER:
3279 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3280 break;
3281
3282 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
3283 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3284 nargs = 1;
3285 break;
3286
3287 case TERNOP_SLICE:
3288 *pos += 1;
3289 nargs = 3;
3290 break;
3291
3292 case OP_STRING:
3293 break;
3294
3295 default:
3296 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
3297 }
3298
3299 argvec = (struct value * *) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 1));
3300 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
3301 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
3302 argvec[i] = NULL;
3303 exp = *expp;
3304
3305 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
3306 switch (op)
3307 {
3308 default:
3309 break;
3310
3311 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3312 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3313 {
3314 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3315 int n_candidates;
3316
3317 n_candidates =
3318 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
3319 (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
3320 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3321 &candidates);
3322
3323 if (n_candidates > 1)
3324 {
3325 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
3326 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
3327 out all types. */
3328 int j;
3329 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
3330 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym))
3331 {
3332 case LOC_REGISTER:
3333 case LOC_ARG:
3334 case LOC_REF_ARG:
3335 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
3336 case LOC_LOCAL:
3337 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3338 goto FoundNonType;
3339 default:
3340 break;
3341 }
3342 FoundNonType:
3343 if (j < n_candidates)
3344 {
3345 j = 0;
3346 while (j < n_candidates)
3347 {
3348 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
3349 {
3350 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
3351 n_candidates -= 1;
3352 }
3353 else
3354 j += 1;
3355 }
3356 }
3357 }
3358
3359 if (n_candidates == 0)
3360 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
3361 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3362 else if (n_candidates == 1)
3363 i = 0;
3364 else if (deprocedure_p
3365 && !is_nonfunction (candidates, n_candidates))
3366 {
3367 i = ada_resolve_function
3368 (candidates, n_candidates, NULL, 0,
3369 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
3370 context_type);
3371 if (i < 0)
3372 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3373 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3374 }
3375 else
3376 {
3377 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
3378 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3379 user_select_syms (candidates, n_candidates, 1);
3380 i = 0;
3381 }
3382
3383 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
3384 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
3385 if (innermost_block == NULL
3386 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
3387 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
3388 }
3389
3390 if (deprocedure_p
3391 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))
3392 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC))
3393 {
3394 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 0,
3395 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
3396 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
3397 exp = *expp;
3398 }
3399 break;
3400
3401 case OP_FUNCALL:
3402 {
3403 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3404 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3405 {
3406 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3407 int n_candidates;
3408
3409 n_candidates =
3410 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
3411 (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
3412 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3413 &candidates);
3414 if (n_candidates == 1)
3415 i = 0;
3416 else
3417 {
3418 i = ada_resolve_function
3419 (candidates, n_candidates,
3420 argvec, nargs,
3421 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
3422 context_type);
3423 if (i < 0)
3424 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3425 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
3426 }
3427
3428 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
3429 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
3430 if (innermost_block == NULL
3431 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
3432 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
3433 }
3434 }
3435 break;
3436 case BINOP_ADD:
3437 case BINOP_SUB:
3438 case BINOP_MUL:
3439 case BINOP_DIV:
3440 case BINOP_REM:
3441 case BINOP_MOD:
3442 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3443 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3444 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3445 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3446 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3447 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3448 case BINOP_LESS:
3449 case BINOP_GTR:
3450 case BINOP_LEQ:
3451 case BINOP_GEQ:
3452 case BINOP_EXP:
3453 case UNOP_NEG:
3454 case UNOP_PLUS:
3455 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3456 case UNOP_ABS:
3457 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
3458 {
3459 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3460 int n_candidates;
3461
3462 n_candidates =
3463 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_encode (ada_decoded_op_name (op)),
3464 (struct block *) NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
3465 &candidates);
3466 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates, n_candidates, argvec, nargs,
3467 ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL);
3468 if (i < 0)
3469 break;
3470
3471 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
3472 candidates[i].sym, candidates[i].block);
3473 exp = *expp;
3474 }
3475 break;
3476
3477 case OP_TYPE:
3478 case OP_REGISTER:
3479 return NULL;
3480 }
3481
3482 *pos = pc;
3483 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
3484 }
3485
3486 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
3487 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
3488 a non-pointer. */
3489 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
3490 liberal. */
3491
3492 static int
3493 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
3494 {
3495 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
3496 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
3497
3498 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3499 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
3500 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3501 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
3502
3503 switch (TYPE_CODE (ftype))
3504 {
3505 default:
3506 return TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE (atype);
3507 case TYPE_CODE_PTR:
3508 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3509 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
3510 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
3511 else
3512 return (may_deref
3513 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
3514 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3515 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3516 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3517 switch (TYPE_CODE (atype))
3518 {
3519 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3520 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3521 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3522 return 1;
3523 default:
3524 return 0;
3525 }
3526
3527 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3528 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3529 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3530
3531 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3532 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3533 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3534 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3535 else
3536 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3537 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3538
3539 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3540 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3541 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE (ftype));
3542 }
3543 }
3544
3545 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3546 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3547 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3548 argument function. */
3549
3550 static int
3551 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3552 {
3553 int i;
3554 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3555
3556 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3557 && TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3558 return (n_actuals == 0);
3559 else if (func_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (func_type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3560 return 0;
3561
3562 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals)
3563 return 0;
3564
3565 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3566 {
3567 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3568 return 0;
3569 else
3570 {
3571 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type,
3572 i));
3573 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3574
3575 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3576 return 0;
3577 }
3578 }
3579 return 1;
3580 }
3581
3582 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3583 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3584 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3585 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3586
3587 static int
3588 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3589 {
3590 struct type *return_type;
3591
3592 if (func_type == NULL)
3593 return 1;
3594
3595 if (TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3596 return_type = get_base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3597 else
3598 return_type = get_base_type (func_type);
3599 if (return_type == NULL)
3600 return 1;
3601
3602 context_type = get_base_type (context_type);
3603
3604 if (TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3605 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3606 else if (context_type == NULL)
3607 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3608 else
3609 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE (context_type);
3610 }
3611
3612
3613 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3614 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3615 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3616 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3617 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3618 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3619
3620 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3621 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3622 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3623 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3624
3625 static int
3626 ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info syms[],
3627 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3628 const char *name, struct type *context_type)
3629 {
3630 int fallback;
3631 int k;
3632 int m; /* Number of hits */
3633
3634 m = 0;
3635 /* In the first pass of the loop, we only accept functions matching
3636 context_type. If none are found, we add a second pass of the loop
3637 where every function is accepted. */
3638 for (fallback = 0; m == 0 && fallback < 2; fallback++)
3639 {
3640 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3641 {
3642 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].sym));
3643
3644 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].sym, args, nargs)
3645 && (fallback || return_match (type, context_type)))
3646 {
3647 syms[m] = syms[k];
3648 m += 1;
3649 }
3650 }
3651 }
3652
3653 if (m == 0)
3654 return -1;
3655 else if (m > 1)
3656 {
3657 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
3658 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
3659 return 0;
3660 }
3661 return 0;
3662 }
3663
3664 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3665 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3666 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3667 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3668 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3669
3670 static int
3671 encoded_ordered_before (const char *N0, const char *N1)
3672 {
3673 if (N1 == NULL)
3674 return 0;
3675 else if (N0 == NULL)
3676 return 1;
3677 else
3678 {
3679 int k0, k1;
3680
3681 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3682 ;
3683 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3684 ;
3685 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3686 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3687 {
3688 int n0, n1;
3689
3690 n0 = k0;
3691 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3692 n0 -= 1;
3693 n1 = k1;
3694 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3695 n1 -= 1;
3696 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3697 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3698 }
3699 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3700 }
3701 }
3702
3703 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3704 encoded names. */
3705
3706 static void
3707 sort_choices (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int nsyms)
3708 {
3709 int i;
3710
3711 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3712 {
3713 struct ada_symbol_info sym = syms[i];
3714 int j;
3715
3716 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3717 {
3718 if (encoded_ordered_before (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
3719 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym.sym)))
3720 break;
3721 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3722 }
3723 syms[j + 1] = sym;
3724 }
3725 }
3726
3727 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3728 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3729 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3730 selected. */
3731
3732 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3733 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3734
3735 int
3736 user_select_syms (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3737 {
3738 int i;
3739 int *chosen = (int *) alloca (sizeof (int) * nsyms);
3740 int n_chosen;
3741 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3742 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3743
3744 if (max_results < 1)
3745 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3746 if (nsyms <= 1)
3747 return nsyms;
3748
3749 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3750 error (_("\
3751 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3752 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3753
3754 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3755 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3756 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3757 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3758 return nsyms;
3759
3760 printf_unfiltered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3761 if (max_results > 1)
3762 printf_unfiltered (_("[1] all\n"));
3763
3764 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3765
3766 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3767 {
3768 if (syms[i].sym == NULL)
3769 continue;
3770
3771 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_BLOCK)
3772 {
3773 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3774 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].sym, 1);
3775
3776 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3777 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at <no source file available>:%d\n"),
3778 i + first_choice,
3779 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3780 sal.line);
3781 else
3782 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"), i + first_choice,
3783 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3784 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal.symtab),
3785 sal.line);
3786 continue;
3787 }
3788 else
3789 {
3790 int is_enumeral =
3791 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_CONST
3792 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym) != NULL
3793 && TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3794 struct symtab *symtab = NULL;
3795
3796 if (SYMBOL_OBJFILE_OWNED (syms[i].sym))
3797 symtab = symbol_symtab (syms[i].sym);
3798
3799 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3800 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"),
3801 i + first_choice,
3802 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3803 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab),
3804 SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym));
3805 else if (is_enumeral
3806 && TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != NULL)
3807 {
3808 printf_unfiltered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3809 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym), NULL,
3810 gdb_stdout, -1, 0, &type_print_raw_options);
3811 printf_unfiltered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3812 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3813 }
3814 else if (symtab != NULL)
3815 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3816 ? _("[%d] %s in %s (enumeral)\n")
3817 : _("[%d] %s at %s:?\n"),
3818 i + first_choice,
3819 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3820 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab));
3821 else
3822 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3823 ? _("[%d] %s (enumeral)\n")
3824 : _("[%d] %s at ?\n"),
3825 i + first_choice,
3826 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3827 }
3828 }
3829
3830 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3831 "overload-choice");
3832
3833 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3834 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3835
3836 return n_chosen;
3837 }
3838
3839 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3840 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3841 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3842
3843 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3844 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3845
3846 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3847 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3848 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3849
3850 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3851
3852 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3853 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3854
3855 int
3856 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3857 int is_all_choice, char *annotation_suffix)
3858 {
3859 char *args;
3860 char *prompt;
3861 int n_chosen;
3862 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3863
3864 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3865 if (prompt == NULL)
3866 prompt = "> ";
3867
3868 args = command_line_input (prompt, 0, annotation_suffix);
3869
3870 if (args == NULL)
3871 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3872
3873 n_chosen = 0;
3874
3875 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3876 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3877 while (1)
3878 {
3879 char *args2;
3880 int choice, j;
3881
3882 args = skip_spaces (args);
3883 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3884 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3885 else if (*args == '\0')
3886 break;
3887
3888 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3889 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3890 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3891 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3892 args = args2;
3893
3894 if (choice == 0)
3895 error (_("cancelled"));
3896
3897 if (choice < first_choice)
3898 {
3899 n_chosen = n_choices;
3900 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3901 choices[j] = j;
3902 break;
3903 }
3904 choice -= first_choice;
3905
3906 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3907 {
3908 }
3909
3910 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3911 {
3912 int k;
3913
3914 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3915 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3916 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3917 n_chosen += 1;
3918 }
3919 }
3920
3921 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3922 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3923
3924 return n_chosen;
3925 }
3926
3927 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
3928 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
3929 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
3930
3931 static void
3932 replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **expp, int pc, int nargs,
3933 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
3934 const struct block *block)
3935 {
3936 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
3937 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
3938 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
3939 xzalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
3940 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
3941 struct expression *exp = *expp;
3942
3943 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
3944 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
3945 newexp->gdbarch = exp->gdbarch;
3946 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
3947 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
3948 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
3949
3950 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
3951 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
3952
3953 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
3954 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
3955 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
3956
3957 *expp = newexp;
3958 xfree (exp);
3959 }
3960
3961 /* Type-class predicates */
3962
3963 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
3964 or FLOAT). */
3965
3966 static int
3967 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
3968 {
3969 if (type == NULL)
3970 return 0;
3971 else
3972 {
3973 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3974 {
3975 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3976 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3977 return 1;
3978 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3979 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3980 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3981 default:
3982 return 0;
3983 }
3984 }
3985 }
3986
3987 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
3988
3989 static int
3990 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
3991 {
3992 if (type == NULL)
3993 return 0;
3994 else
3995 {
3996 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3997 {
3998 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3999 return 1;
4000 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4001 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
4002 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
4003 default:
4004 return 0;
4005 }
4006 }
4007 }
4008
4009 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
4010
4011 static int
4012 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
4013 {
4014 if (type == NULL)
4015 return 0;
4016 else
4017 {
4018 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
4019 {
4020 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4021 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4022 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
4023 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
4024 return 1;
4025 default:
4026 return 0;
4027 }
4028 }
4029 }
4030
4031 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
4032
4033 static int
4034 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
4035 {
4036 if (type == NULL)
4037 return 0;
4038 else
4039 {
4040 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
4041 {
4042 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4043 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4044 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
4045 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
4046 return 1;
4047 default:
4048 return 0;
4049 }
4050 }
4051 }
4052
4053 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
4054 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
4055 (i.e., result 0). */
4056
4057 static int
4058 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
4059 {
4060 struct type *type0 =
4061 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
4062 struct type *type1 =
4063 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
4064
4065 if (type0 == NULL)
4066 return 0;
4067
4068 switch (op)
4069 {
4070 default:
4071 return 0;
4072
4073 case BINOP_ADD:
4074 case BINOP_SUB:
4075 case BINOP_MUL:
4076 case BINOP_DIV:
4077 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
4078
4079 case BINOP_REM:
4080 case BINOP_MOD:
4081 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
4082 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
4083 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
4084 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
4085
4086 case BINOP_EQUAL:
4087 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
4088 case BINOP_LESS:
4089 case BINOP_GTR:
4090 case BINOP_LEQ:
4091 case BINOP_GEQ:
4092 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
4093
4094 case BINOP_CONCAT:
4095 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
4096
4097 case BINOP_EXP:
4098 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
4099
4100 case UNOP_NEG:
4101 case UNOP_PLUS:
4102 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
4103 case UNOP_ABS:
4104 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
4105
4106 }
4107 }
4108 \f
4109 /* Renaming */
4110
4111 /* NOTES:
4112
4113 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
4114 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
4115 point.
4116 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
4117 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
4118 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
4119 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
4120 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
4121 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
4122
4123 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
4124
4125 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
4126
4127 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
4128 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
4129 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
4130 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
4131 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
4132 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
4133 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
4134 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
4135 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
4136 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
4137 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
4138 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
4139
4140 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
4141
4142 enum ada_renaming_category
4143 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
4144 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
4145 const char **renaming_expr)
4146 {
4147 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
4148 const char *info;
4149 const char *suffix;
4150
4151 if (sym == NULL)
4152 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4153 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
4154 {
4155 default:
4156 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4157 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4158 return parse_old_style_renaming (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym),
4159 renamed_entity, len, renaming_expr);
4160 case LOC_LOCAL:
4161 case LOC_STATIC:
4162 case LOC_COMPUTED:
4163 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
4164 info = strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR");
4165 if (info == NULL)
4166 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4167 switch (info[5])
4168 {
4169 case '_':
4170 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
4171 info += 6;
4172 break;
4173 case 'E':
4174 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
4175 info += 7;
4176 break;
4177 case 'P':
4178 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
4179 info += 7;
4180 break;
4181 case 'S':
4182 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
4183 info += 7;
4184 break;
4185 default:
4186 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4187 }
4188 }
4189
4190 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
4191 *renamed_entity = info;
4192 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
4193 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
4194 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4195 if (len != NULL)
4196 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
4197 suffix += 5;
4198 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
4199 *renaming_expr = suffix;
4200 return kind;
4201 }
4202
4203 /* Assuming TYPE encodes a renaming according to the old encoding in
4204 exp_dbug.ads, returns details of that renaming in *RENAMED_ENTITY,
4205 *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR, as for ada_parse_renaming, above. Returns
4206 ADA_NOT_RENAMING otherwise. */
4207 static enum ada_renaming_category
4208 parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *type,
4209 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
4210 const char **renaming_expr)
4211 {
4212 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
4213 const char *name;
4214 const char *info;
4215 const char *suffix;
4216
4217 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4218 || TYPE_NFIELDS (type) != 1)
4219 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4220
4221 name = type_name_no_tag (type);
4222 if (name == NULL)
4223 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4224
4225 name = strstr (name, "___XR");
4226 if (name == NULL)
4227 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4228 switch (name[5])
4229 {
4230 case '\0':
4231 case '_':
4232 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
4233 break;
4234 case 'E':
4235 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
4236 break;
4237 case 'P':
4238 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
4239 break;
4240 case 'S':
4241 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
4242 break;
4243 default:
4244 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4245 }
4246
4247 info = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0);
4248 if (info == NULL)
4249 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4250 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
4251 *renamed_entity = info;
4252 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
4253 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
4254 *renaming_expr = suffix + 5;
4255 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
4256 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4257 if (len != NULL)
4258 *len = suffix - info;
4259 return kind;
4260 }
4261
4262 /* Compute the value of the given RENAMING_SYM, which is expected to
4263 be a symbol encoding a renaming expression. BLOCK is the block
4264 used to evaluate the renaming. */
4265
4266 static struct value *
4267 ada_read_renaming_var_value (struct symbol *renaming_sym,
4268 const struct block *block)
4269 {
4270 const char *sym_name;
4271 struct expression *expr;
4272 struct value *value;
4273 struct cleanup *old_chain = NULL;
4274
4275 sym_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (renaming_sym);
4276 expr = parse_exp_1 (&sym_name, 0, block, 0);
4277 old_chain = make_cleanup (free_current_contents, &expr);
4278 value = evaluate_expression (expr);
4279
4280 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4281 return value;
4282 }
4283 \f
4284
4285 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
4286
4287 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
4288 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of allocating memory
4289 in the inferior where a copy of the value contents is copied. */
4290
4291 static struct value *
4292 ensure_lval (struct value *val)
4293 {
4294 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == not_lval
4295 || VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_internalvar)
4296 {
4297 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
4298 const CORE_ADDR addr =
4299 value_as_long (value_allocate_space_in_inferior (len));
4300
4301 set_value_address (val, addr);
4302 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
4303 write_memory (addr, value_contents (val), len);
4304 }
4305
4306 return val;
4307 }
4308
4309 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
4310 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
4311 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
4312 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
4313
4314 struct value *
4315 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0)
4316 {
4317 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4318 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
4319 struct type *formal_target =
4320 TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4321 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
4322 struct type *actual_target =
4323 TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4324 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
4325
4326 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
4327 && TYPE_CODE (actual_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
4328 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual);
4329 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4330 || TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4331 {
4332 struct value *result;
4333
4334 if (TYPE_CODE (formal_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
4335 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
4336 result = desc_data (actual);
4337 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4338 {
4339 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
4340 {
4341 struct value *val;
4342
4343 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4344 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
4345 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
4346 (char *) value_contents (actual),
4347 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
4348 actual = ensure_lval (val);
4349 }
4350 result = value_addr (actual);
4351 }
4352 else
4353 return actual;
4354 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result, 0);
4355 }
4356 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4357 return ada_value_ind (actual);
4358 else if (ada_is_aligner_type (formal_type))
4359 {
4360 /* We need to turn this parameter into an aligner type
4361 as well. */
4362 struct value *aligner = allocate_value (formal_type);
4363 struct value *component = ada_value_struct_elt (aligner, "F", 0);
4364
4365 value_assign_to_component (aligner, component, actual);
4366 return aligner;
4367 }
4368
4369 return actual;
4370 }
4371
4372 /* Convert VALUE (which must be an address) to a CORE_ADDR that is a pointer of
4373 type TYPE. This is usually an inefficient no-op except on some targets
4374 (such as AVR) where the representation of a pointer and an address
4375 differs. */
4376
4377 static CORE_ADDR
4378 value_pointer (struct value *value, struct type *type)
4379 {
4380 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_type_arch (type);
4381 unsigned len = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
4382 gdb_byte *buf = alloca (len);
4383 CORE_ADDR addr;
4384
4385 addr = value_address (value);
4386 gdbarch_address_to_pointer (gdbarch, type, buf, addr);
4387 addr = extract_unsigned_integer (buf, len, gdbarch_byte_order (gdbarch));
4388 return addr;
4389 }
4390
4391
4392 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
4393 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
4394 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
4395 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
4396 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
4397
4398 static struct value *
4399 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr)
4400 {
4401 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
4402 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
4403 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
4404 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
4405 int i;
4406
4407 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr)));
4408 i > 0; i -= 1)
4409 {
4410 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4411 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0),
4412 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
4413 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
4414 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4415 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1),
4416 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
4417 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
4418 }
4419
4420 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds);
4421
4422 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4423 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4424 value_pointer (ensure_lval (arr),
4425 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 0)),
4426 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
4427 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
4428
4429 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4430 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4431 value_pointer (bounds,
4432 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 1)),
4433 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
4434 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
4435
4436 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor);
4437
4438 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4439 return value_addr (descriptor);
4440 else
4441 return descriptor;
4442 }
4443 \f
4444 /* Symbol Cache Module */
4445
4446 /* Performance measurements made as of 2010-01-15 indicate that
4447 this cache does bring some noticeable improvements. Depending
4448 on the type of entity being printed, the cache can make it as much
4449 as an order of magnitude faster than without it.
4450
4451 The descriptive type DWARF extension has significantly reduced
4452 the need for this cache, at least when DWARF is being used. However,
4453 even in this case, some expensive name-based symbol searches are still
4454 sometimes necessary - to find an XVZ variable, mostly. */
4455
4456 /* Initialize the contents of SYM_CACHE. */
4457
4458 static void
4459 ada_init_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache)
4460 {
4461 obstack_init (&sym_cache->cache_space);
4462 memset (sym_cache->root, '\000', sizeof (sym_cache->root));
4463 }
4464
4465 /* Free the memory used by SYM_CACHE. */
4466
4467 static void
4468 ada_free_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache)
4469 {
4470 obstack_free (&sym_cache->cache_space, NULL);
4471 xfree (sym_cache);
4472 }
4473
4474 /* Return the symbol cache associated to the given program space PSPACE.
4475 If not allocated for this PSPACE yet, allocate and initialize one. */
4476
4477 static struct ada_symbol_cache *
4478 ada_get_symbol_cache (struct program_space *pspace)
4479 {
4480 struct ada_pspace_data *pspace_data = get_ada_pspace_data (pspace);
4481
4482 if (pspace_data->sym_cache == NULL)
4483 {
4484 pspace_data->sym_cache = XCNEW (struct ada_symbol_cache);
4485 ada_init_symbol_cache (pspace_data->sym_cache);
4486 }
4487
4488 return pspace_data->sym_cache;
4489 }
4490
4491 /* Clear all entries from the symbol cache. */
4492
4493 static void
4494 ada_clear_symbol_cache (void)
4495 {
4496 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4497 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4498
4499 obstack_free (&sym_cache->cache_space, NULL);
4500 ada_init_symbol_cache (sym_cache);
4501 }
4502
4503 /* Search our cache for an entry matching NAME and DOMAIN.
4504 Return it if found, or NULL otherwise. */
4505
4506 static struct cache_entry **
4507 find_entry (const char *name, domain_enum domain)
4508 {
4509 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4510 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4511 int h = msymbol_hash (name) % HASH_SIZE;
4512 struct cache_entry **e;
4513
4514 for (e = &sym_cache->root[h]; *e != NULL; e = &(*e)->next)
4515 {
4516 if (domain == (*e)->domain && strcmp (name, (*e)->name) == 0)
4517 return e;
4518 }
4519 return NULL;
4520 }
4521
4522 /* Search the symbol cache for an entry matching NAME and DOMAIN.
4523 Return 1 if found, 0 otherwise.
4524
4525 If an entry was found and SYM is not NULL, set *SYM to the entry's
4526 SYM. Same principle for BLOCK if not NULL. */
4527
4528 static int
4529 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum domain,
4530 struct symbol **sym, const struct block **block)
4531 {
4532 struct cache_entry **e = find_entry (name, domain);
4533
4534 if (e == NULL)
4535 return 0;
4536 if (sym != NULL)
4537 *sym = (*e)->sym;
4538 if (block != NULL)
4539 *block = (*e)->block;
4540 return 1;
4541 }
4542
4543 /* Assuming that (SYM, BLOCK) is the result of the lookup of NAME
4544 in domain DOMAIN, save this result in our symbol cache. */
4545
4546 static void
4547 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum domain, struct symbol *sym,
4548 const struct block *block)
4549 {
4550 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4551 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4552 int h;
4553 char *copy;
4554 struct cache_entry *e;
4555
4556 /* Symbols for builtin types don't have a block.
4557 For now don't cache such symbols. */
4558 if (sym != NULL && !SYMBOL_OBJFILE_OWNED (sym))
4559 return;
4560
4561 /* If the symbol is a local symbol, then do not cache it, as a search
4562 for that symbol depends on the context. To determine whether
4563 the symbol is local or not, we check the block where we found it
4564 against the global and static blocks of its associated symtab. */
4565 if (sym
4566 && BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (SYMTAB_BLOCKVECTOR (symbol_symtab (sym)),
4567 GLOBAL_BLOCK) != block
4568 && BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (SYMTAB_BLOCKVECTOR (symbol_symtab (sym)),
4569 STATIC_BLOCK) != block)
4570 return;
4571
4572 h = msymbol_hash (name) % HASH_SIZE;
4573 e = (struct cache_entry *) obstack_alloc (&sym_cache->cache_space,
4574 sizeof (*e));
4575 e->next = sym_cache->root[h];
4576 sym_cache->root[h] = e;
4577 e->name = copy = obstack_alloc (&sym_cache->cache_space, strlen (name) + 1);
4578 strcpy (copy, name);
4579 e->sym = sym;
4580 e->domain = domain;
4581 e->block = block;
4582 }
4583 \f
4584 /* Symbol Lookup */
4585
4586 /* Return nonzero if wild matching should be used when searching for
4587 all symbols matching LOOKUP_NAME.
4588
4589 LOOKUP_NAME is expected to be a symbol name after transformation
4590 for Ada lookups (see ada_name_for_lookup). */
4591
4592 static int
4593 should_use_wild_match (const char *lookup_name)
4594 {
4595 return (strstr (lookup_name, "__") == NULL);
4596 }
4597
4598 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
4599 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
4600
4601 static struct symbol *
4602 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
4603 domain_enum domain)
4604 {
4605 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
4606 struct symbol *sym = NULL;
4607
4608 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym, NULL))
4609 return sym;
4610 sym = lookup_symbol_in_language (name, block, domain, language_c, 0);
4611 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym, block_found);
4612 return sym;
4613 }
4614
4615
4616 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
4617 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
4618 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
4619 static int
4620 is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int n)
4621 {
4622 int i;
4623
4624 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
4625 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
4626 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4627 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) != LOC_CONST))
4628 return 1;
4629
4630 return 0;
4631 }
4632
4633 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
4634 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
4635
4636 static int
4637 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
4638 {
4639 if (type0 == type1)
4640 return 1;
4641 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
4642 || TYPE_CODE (type0) != TYPE_CODE (type1))
4643 return 0;
4644 if ((TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
4645 || TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4646 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
4647 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
4648 return 1;
4649
4650 return 0;
4651 }
4652
4653 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
4654 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
4655
4656 static int
4657 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
4658 {
4659 if (sym0 == sym1)
4660 return 1;
4661 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
4662 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
4663 return 0;
4664
4665 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
4666 {
4667 case LOC_UNDEF:
4668 return 1;
4669 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4670 {
4671 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
4672 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
4673 const char *name0 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym0);
4674 const char *name1 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym1);
4675 int len0 = strlen (name0);
4676
4677 return
4678 TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE (type1)
4679 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
4680 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
4681 && startswith (name1 + len0, "___XV")));
4682 }
4683 case LOC_CONST:
4684 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
4685 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
4686 default:
4687 return 0;
4688 }
4689 }
4690
4691 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct ada_symbol_info
4692 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
4693
4694 static void
4695 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4696 struct symbol *sym,
4697 const struct block *block)
4698 {
4699 int i;
4700 struct ada_symbol_info *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4701
4702 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4703 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4704 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4705 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4706 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4707 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4708 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4709 out the stub ones if needed. */
4710
4711 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4712 {
4713 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].sym))
4714 return;
4715 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].sym, sym))
4716 {
4717 prevDefns[i].sym = sym;
4718 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4719 return;
4720 }
4721 }
4722
4723 {
4724 struct ada_symbol_info info;
4725
4726 info.sym = sym;
4727 info.block = block;
4728 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
4729 }
4730 }
4731
4732 /* Number of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in
4733 current vector in *OBSTACKP. */
4734
4735 static int
4736 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4737 {
4738 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info);
4739 }
4740
4741 /* Vector of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in current
4742 vector in *OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return
4743 its final address. */
4744
4745 static struct ada_symbol_info *
4746 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4747 {
4748 if (finish)
4749 return obstack_finish (obstackp);
4750 else
4751 return (struct ada_symbol_info *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4752 }
4753
4754 /* Return a bound minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada
4755 decoding rules. Returns an invalid symbol if there is no such
4756 minimal symbol. Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled
4757 specially: "standard__" is first stripped off, and only static and
4758 global symbols are searched. */
4759
4760 struct bound_minimal_symbol
4761 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4762 {
4763 struct bound_minimal_symbol result;
4764 struct objfile *objfile;
4765 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
4766 const int wild_match_p = should_use_wild_match (name);
4767
4768 memset (&result, 0, sizeof (result));
4769
4770 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
4771 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
4772 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
4773 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
4774 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
4775 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
4776 entity inside its program). */
4777 if (startswith (name, "standard__"))
4778 name += sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4779
4780 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
4781 {
4782 if (match_name (MSYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), name, wild_match_p)
4783 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4784 {
4785 result.minsym = msymbol;
4786 result.objfile = objfile;
4787 break;
4788 }
4789 }
4790
4791 return result;
4792 }
4793
4794 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4795 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4796 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4797 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD_MATCH_P, treat as NAME
4798 with a wildcard prefix. */
4799
4800 static void
4801 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4802 const char *name, domain_enum domain,
4803 int wild_match_p)
4804 {
4805 }
4806
4807 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4808 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4809
4810 static int
4811 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4812 {
4813 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4814
4815 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4816 }
4817
4818 /* Return nonzero if TYPE1 and TYPE2 are two enumeration types
4819 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes.
4820
4821 This function assumes that TYPE1 and TYPE2 are both TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4822 types and that their number of enumerals is identical (in other
4823 words, TYPE_NFIELDS (type1) == TYPE_NFIELDS (type2)). */
4824
4825 static int
4826 ada_identical_enum_types_p (struct type *type1, struct type *type2)
4827 {
4828 int i;
4829
4830 /* The heuristic we use here is fairly conservative. We consider
4831 that 2 enumerate types are identical if they have the same
4832 number of enumerals and that all enumerals have the same
4833 underlying value and name. */
4834
4835 /* All enums in the type should have an identical underlying value. */
4836 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4837 if (TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type1, i) != TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type2, i))
4838 return 0;
4839
4840 /* All enumerals should also have the same name (modulo any numerical
4841 suffix). */
4842 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4843 {
4844 const char *name_1 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i);
4845 const char *name_2 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i);
4846 int len_1 = strlen (name_1);
4847 int len_2 = strlen (name_2);
4848
4849 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i), &len_1);
4850 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i), &len_2);
4851 if (len_1 != len_2
4852 || strncmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i),
4853 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i),
4854 len_1) != 0)
4855 return 0;
4856 }
4857
4858 return 1;
4859 }
4860
4861 /* Return nonzero if all the symbols in SYMS are all enumeral symbols
4862 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes. Sometimes,
4863 enumerals are not strictly identical, but their types are so similar
4864 that they can be considered identical.
4865
4866 For instance, consider the following code:
4867
4868 type Color is (Black, Red, Green, Blue, White);
4869 type RGB_Color is new Color range Red .. Blue;
4870
4871 Type RGB_Color is a subrange of an implicit type which is a copy
4872 of type Color. If we call that implicit type RGB_ColorB ("B" is
4873 for "Base Type"), then type RGB_ColorB is a copy of type Color.
4874 As a result, when an expression references any of the enumeral
4875 by name (Eg. "print green"), the expression is technically
4876 ambiguous and the user should be asked to disambiguate. But
4877 doing so would only hinder the user, since it wouldn't matter
4878 what choice he makes, the outcome would always be the same.
4879 So, for practical purposes, we consider them as the same. */
4880
4881 static int
4882 symbols_are_identical_enums (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4883 {
4884 int i;
4885
4886 /* Before performing a thorough comparison check of each type,
4887 we perform a series of inexpensive checks. We expect that these
4888 checks will quickly fail in the vast majority of cases, and thus
4889 help prevent the unnecessary use of a more expensive comparison.
4890 Said comparison also expects us to make some of these checks
4891 (see ada_identical_enum_types_p). */
4892
4893 /* Quick check: All symbols should have an enum type. */
4894 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i++)
4895 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4896 return 0;
4897
4898 /* Quick check: They should all have the same value. */
4899 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4900 if (SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[i].sym) != SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[0].sym))
4901 return 0;
4902
4903 /* Quick check: They should all have the same number of enumerals. */
4904 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4905 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4906 != TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].sym)))
4907 return 0;
4908
4909 /* All the sanity checks passed, so we might have a set of
4910 identical enumeration types. Perform a more complete
4911 comparison of the type of each symbol. */
4912 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4913 if (!ada_identical_enum_types_p (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym),
4914 SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].sym)))
4915 return 0;
4916
4917 return 1;
4918 }
4919
4920 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS[0 .. NSYMS-1] that definitely
4921 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
4922 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
4923 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
4924 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
4925 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
4926
4927 static int
4928 remove_extra_symbols (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4929 {
4930 int i, j;
4931
4932 /* We should never be called with less than 2 symbols, as there
4933 cannot be any extra symbol in that case. But it's easy to
4934 handle, since we have nothing to do in that case. */
4935 if (nsyms < 2)
4936 return nsyms;
4937
4938 i = 0;
4939 while (i < nsyms)
4940 {
4941 int remove_p = 0;
4942
4943 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type,
4944 the get rid of the stub. */
4945
4946 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4947 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL)
4948 {
4949 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j++)
4950 {
4951 if (j != i
4952 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[j].sym))
4953 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4954 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4955 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0)
4956 remove_p = 1;
4957 }
4958 }
4959
4960 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address
4961 should be identical. */
4962
4963 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL
4964 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_STATIC
4965 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)))
4966 {
4967 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4968 {
4969 if (i != j
4970 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4971 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4972 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0
4973 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[j].sym)
4974 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[i].sym)
4975 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[j].sym))
4976 remove_p = 1;
4977 }
4978 }
4979
4980 if (remove_p)
4981 {
4982 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4983 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4984 nsyms -= 1;
4985 }
4986
4987 i += 1;
4988 }
4989
4990 /* If all the remaining symbols are identical enumerals, then
4991 just keep the first one and discard the rest.
4992
4993 Unlike what we did previously, we do not discard any entry
4994 unless they are ALL identical. This is because the symbol
4995 comparison is not a strict comparison, but rather a practical
4996 comparison. If all symbols are considered identical, then
4997 we can just go ahead and use the first one and discard the rest.
4998 But if we cannot reduce the list to a single element, we have
4999 to ask the user to disambiguate anyways. And if we have to
5000 present a multiple-choice menu, it's less confusing if the list
5001 isn't missing some choices that were identical and yet distinct. */
5002 if (symbols_are_identical_enums (syms, nsyms))
5003 nsyms = 1;
5004
5005 return nsyms;
5006 }
5007
5008 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
5009 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
5010 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
5011 defined. The string returned needs to be deallocated after use. */
5012
5013 static char *
5014 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
5015 {
5016 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
5017 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
5018 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
5019 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
5020
5021 const char *name = type_name_no_tag (renaming_type);
5022 char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
5023 char *last;
5024 int scope_len;
5025 char *scope;
5026
5027 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
5028 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
5029
5030 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
5031 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
5032 break;
5033
5034 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
5035
5036 scope_len = last - name;
5037 scope = (char *) xmalloc ((scope_len + 1) * sizeof (char));
5038
5039 strncpy (scope, name, scope_len);
5040 scope[scope_len] = '\0';
5041
5042 return scope;
5043 }
5044
5045 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
5046
5047 static int
5048 is_package_name (const char *name)
5049 {
5050 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
5051 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
5052 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
5053 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
5054 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
5055
5056 char *fun_name;
5057
5058 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
5059 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
5060 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
5061 return 0;
5062
5063 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
5064 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
5065
5066 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
5067 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
5068 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
5069 return 0;
5070
5071 fun_name = xstrprintf ("_ada_%s", name);
5072
5073 return (standard_lookup (fun_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
5074 }
5075
5076 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
5077 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
5078
5079 static int
5080 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, const char *function_name)
5081 {
5082 char *scope;
5083 struct cleanup *old_chain;
5084
5085 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
5086 return 0;
5087
5088 scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
5089 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, scope);
5090
5091 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
5092 if (is_package_name (scope))
5093 {
5094 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5095 return 0;
5096 }
5097
5098 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
5099 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
5100
5101 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
5102 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
5103 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
5104 this prefix. */
5105 if (startswith (function_name, "_ada_"))
5106 function_name += 5;
5107
5108 {
5109 int is_invisible = !startswith (function_name, scope);
5110
5111 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5112 return is_invisible;
5113 }
5114 }
5115
5116 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
5117 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
5118 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
5119 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
5120 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
5121
5122 Rationale:
5123 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
5124 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
5125 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
5126 latter.
5127
5128 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
5129 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
5130 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
5131 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
5132 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
5133 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
5134 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
5135
5136 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
5137 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
5138 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
5139 method with the current information available. The implementation
5140 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
5141
5142 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
5143 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
5144 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
5145 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
5146 currently not the case.
5147
5148 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
5149 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
5150 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
5151 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
5152
5153 static int
5154 remove_irrelevant_renamings (struct ada_symbol_info *syms,
5155 int nsyms, const struct block *current_block)
5156 {
5157 struct symbol *current_function;
5158 const char *current_function_name;
5159 int i;
5160 int is_new_style_renaming;
5161
5162 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
5163 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
5164 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
5165 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
5166 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
5167 {
5168 struct symbol *sym = syms[i].sym;
5169 const struct block *block = syms[i].block;
5170 const char *name;
5171 const char *suffix;
5172
5173 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
5174 continue;
5175 name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym);
5176 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
5177
5178 if (suffix != NULL)
5179 {
5180 int name_len = suffix - name;
5181 int j;
5182
5183 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
5184 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
5185 if (i != j && syms[j].sym != NULL
5186 && strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
5187 name_len) == 0
5188 && block == syms[j].block)
5189 syms[j].sym = NULL;
5190 }
5191 }
5192 if (is_new_style_renaming)
5193 {
5194 int j, k;
5195
5196 for (j = k = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
5197 if (syms[j].sym != NULL)
5198 {
5199 syms[k] = syms[j];
5200 k += 1;
5201 }
5202 return k;
5203 }
5204
5205 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
5206 Abort if unable to do so. */
5207
5208 if (current_block == NULL)
5209 return nsyms;
5210
5211 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block);
5212 if (current_function == NULL)
5213 return nsyms;
5214
5215 current_function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (current_function);
5216 if (current_function_name == NULL)
5217 return nsyms;
5218
5219 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
5220 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
5221 the current block. */
5222
5223 i = 0;
5224 while (i < nsyms)
5225 {
5226 if (ada_parse_renaming (syms[i].sym, NULL, NULL, NULL)
5227 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
5228 && old_renaming_is_invisible (syms[i].sym, current_function_name))
5229 {
5230 int j;
5231
5232 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
5233 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
5234 nsyms -= 1;
5235 }
5236 else
5237 i += 1;
5238 }
5239
5240 return nsyms;
5241 }
5242
5243 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks)
5244 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively.
5245 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing"
5246 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function,
5247 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions).
5248 If WILD_MATCH_P is nonzero, perform the naming matching in
5249 "wild" mode (see function "wild_match" for more info).
5250
5251 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */
5252
5253 static void
5254 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
5255 const struct block *block, domain_enum domain,
5256 int wild_match_p)
5257 {
5258 int block_depth = 0;
5259
5260 while (block != NULL)
5261 {
5262 block_depth += 1;
5263 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, name, domain, NULL,
5264 wild_match_p);
5265
5266 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
5267 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0),
5268 num_defns_collected (obstackp)))
5269 return;
5270
5271 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
5272 }
5273
5274 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
5275 enclosing subprogram. */
5276 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
5277 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, name, domain, wild_match_p);
5278 }
5279
5280 /* An object of this type is used as the user_data argument when
5281 calling the map_matching_symbols method. */
5282
5283 struct match_data
5284 {
5285 struct objfile *objfile;
5286 struct obstack *obstackp;
5287 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5288 int found_sym;
5289 };
5290
5291 /* A callback for add_matching_symbols that adds SYM, found in BLOCK,
5292 to a list of symbols. DATA0 is a pointer to a struct match_data *
5293 containing the obstack that collects the symbol list, the file that SYM
5294 must come from, a flag indicating whether a non-argument symbol has
5295 been found in the current block, and the last argument symbol
5296 passed in SYM within the current block (if any). When SYM is null,
5297 marking the end of a block, the argument symbol is added if no
5298 other has been found. */
5299
5300 static int
5301 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (struct block *block, struct symbol *sym, void *data0)
5302 {
5303 struct match_data *data = (struct match_data *) data0;
5304
5305 if (sym == NULL)
5306 {
5307 if (!data->found_sym && data->arg_sym != NULL)
5308 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
5309 fixup_symbol_section (data->arg_sym, data->objfile),
5310 block);
5311 data->found_sym = 0;
5312 data->arg_sym = NULL;
5313 }
5314 else
5315 {
5316 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5317 return 0;
5318 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5319 data->arg_sym = sym;
5320 else
5321 {
5322 data->found_sym = 1;
5323 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
5324 fixup_symbol_section (sym, data->objfile),
5325 block);
5326 }
5327 }
5328 return 0;
5329 }
5330
5331 /* Implements compare_names, but only applying the comparision using
5332 the given CASING. */
5333
5334 static int
5335 compare_names_with_case (const char *string1, const char *string2,
5336 enum case_sensitivity casing)
5337 {
5338 while (*string1 != '\0' && *string2 != '\0')
5339 {
5340 char c1, c2;
5341
5342 if (isspace (*string1) || isspace (*string2))
5343 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5344
5345 if (casing == case_sensitive_off)
5346 {
5347 c1 = tolower (*string1);
5348 c2 = tolower (*string2);
5349 }
5350 else
5351 {
5352 c1 = *string1;
5353 c2 = *string2;
5354 }
5355 if (c1 != c2)
5356 break;
5357
5358 string1 += 1;
5359 string2 += 1;
5360 }
5361
5362 switch (*string1)
5363 {
5364 case '(':
5365 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5366 case '_':
5367 if (*string2 == '\0')
5368 {
5369 if (is_name_suffix (string1))
5370 return 0;
5371 else
5372 return 1;
5373 }
5374 /* FALLTHROUGH */
5375 default:
5376 if (*string2 == '(')
5377 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5378 else
5379 {
5380 if (casing == case_sensitive_off)
5381 return tolower (*string1) - tolower (*string2);
5382 else
5383 return *string1 - *string2;
5384 }
5385 }
5386 }
5387
5388 /* Compare STRING1 to STRING2, with results as for strcmp.
5389 Compatible with strcmp_iw_ordered in that...
5390
5391 strcmp_iw_ordered (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
5392
5393 ... implies...
5394
5395 compare_names (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
5396
5397 (they may differ as to what symbols compare equal). */
5398
5399 static int
5400 compare_names (const char *string1, const char *string2)
5401 {
5402 int result;
5403
5404 /* Similar to what strcmp_iw_ordered does, we need to perform
5405 a case-insensitive comparison first, and only resort to
5406 a second, case-sensitive, comparison if the first one was
5407 not sufficient to differentiate the two strings. */
5408
5409 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_off);
5410 if (result == 0)
5411 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_on);
5412
5413 return result;
5414 }
5415
5416 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match
5417 NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on GLOBAL_BLOCK
5418 symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK symbols otherwise. */
5419
5420 static void
5421 add_nonlocal_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
5422 domain_enum domain, int global,
5423 int is_wild_match)
5424 {
5425 struct objfile *objfile;
5426 struct match_data data;
5427
5428 memset (&data, 0, sizeof data);
5429 data.obstackp = obstackp;
5430
5431 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
5432 {
5433 data.objfile = objfile;
5434
5435 if (is_wild_match)
5436 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name, domain, global,
5437 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, &data,
5438 wild_match, NULL);
5439 else
5440 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name, domain, global,
5441 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, &data,
5442 full_match, compare_names);
5443 }
5444
5445 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && global && !is_wild_match)
5446 {
5447 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
5448 {
5449 char *name1 = alloca (strlen (name) + sizeof ("_ada_"));
5450 strcpy (name1, "_ada_");
5451 strcpy (name1 + sizeof ("_ada_") - 1, name);
5452 data.objfile = objfile;
5453 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name1, domain,
5454 global,
5455 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols,
5456 &data,
5457 full_match, compare_names);
5458 }
5459 }
5460 }
5461
5462 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and, if full_search is
5463 non-zero, enclosing scope and in global scopes, returning the number of
5464 matches.
5465 Sets *RESULTS to point to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples,
5466 indicating the symbols found and the blocks and symbol tables (if
5467 any) in which they were found. This vector is transient---good only to
5468 the next call of ada_lookup_symbol_list.
5469
5470 When full_search is non-zero, any non-function/non-enumeral
5471 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK0,
5472 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
5473 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
5474 surrounding BLOCK0, then these alone are returned.
5475
5476 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
5477 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
5478
5479 static int
5480 ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (const char *name0, const struct block *block0,
5481 domain_enum domain,
5482 struct ada_symbol_info **results,
5483 int full_search)
5484 {
5485 struct symbol *sym;
5486 const struct block *block;
5487 const char *name;
5488 const int wild_match_p = should_use_wild_match (name0);
5489 int syms_from_global_search = 0;
5490 int ndefns;
5491
5492 obstack_free (&symbol_list_obstack, NULL);
5493 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
5494
5495 /* Search specified block and its superiors. */
5496
5497 name = name0;
5498 block = block0;
5499
5500 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
5501 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
5502 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
5503 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
5504 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
5505 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
5506 entity inside its program). */
5507 if (startswith (name0, "standard__"))
5508 {
5509 block = NULL;
5510 name = name0 + sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
5511 }
5512
5513 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */
5514
5515 if (block != NULL)
5516 {
5517 if (full_search)
5518 {
5519 ada_add_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, block,
5520 domain, wild_match_p);
5521 }
5522 else
5523 {
5524 /* In the !full_search case we're are being called by
5525 ada_iterate_over_symbols, and we don't want to search
5526 superblocks. */
5527 ada_add_block_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, block, name,
5528 domain, NULL, wild_match_p);
5529 }
5530 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) > 0 || !full_search)
5531 goto done;
5532 }
5533
5534 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have
5535 already performed this search before. If we have, then return
5536 the same result. */
5537
5538 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name0, domain, &sym, &block))
5539 {
5540 if (sym != NULL)
5541 add_defn_to_vec (&symbol_list_obstack, sym, block);
5542 goto done;
5543 }
5544
5545 syms_from_global_search = 1;
5546
5547 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */
5548
5549 add_nonlocal_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, domain, 1,
5550 wild_match_p);
5551
5552 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
5553 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */
5554
5555 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) == 0)
5556 add_nonlocal_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, domain, 0,
5557 wild_match_p);
5558
5559 done:
5560 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack);
5561 *results = defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack, 1);
5562
5563 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (*results, ndefns);
5564
5565 if (ndefns == 0 && full_search && syms_from_global_search)
5566 cache_symbol (name0, domain, NULL, NULL);
5567
5568 if (ndefns == 1 && full_search && syms_from_global_search)
5569 cache_symbol (name0, domain, (*results)[0].sym, (*results)[0].block);
5570
5571 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (*results, ndefns, block0);
5572
5573 return ndefns;
5574 }
5575
5576 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and enclosing scope and
5577 in global scopes, returning the number of matches, and setting *RESULTS
5578 to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples.
5579 See ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker for further details. */
5580
5581 int
5582 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name0, const struct block *block0,
5583 domain_enum domain, struct ada_symbol_info **results)
5584 {
5585 return ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (name0, block0, domain, results, 1);
5586 }
5587
5588 /* Implementation of the la_iterate_over_symbols method. */
5589
5590 static void
5591 ada_iterate_over_symbols (const struct block *block,
5592 const char *name, domain_enum domain,
5593 symbol_found_callback_ftype *callback,
5594 void *data)
5595 {
5596 int ndefs, i;
5597 struct ada_symbol_info *results;
5598
5599 ndefs = ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (name, block, domain, &results, 0);
5600 for (i = 0; i < ndefs; ++i)
5601 {
5602 if (! (*callback) (results[i].sym, data))
5603 break;
5604 }
5605 }
5606
5607 /* If NAME is the name of an entity, return a string that should
5608 be used to look that entity up in Ada units. This string should
5609 be deallocated after use using xfree.
5610
5611 NAME can have any form that the "break" or "print" commands might
5612 recognize. In other words, it does not have to be the "natural"
5613 name, or the "encoded" name. */
5614
5615 char *
5616 ada_name_for_lookup (const char *name)
5617 {
5618 char *canon;
5619 int nlen = strlen (name);
5620
5621 if (name[0] == '<' && name[nlen - 1] == '>')
5622 {
5623 canon = xmalloc (nlen - 1);
5624 memcpy (canon, name + 1, nlen - 2);
5625 canon[nlen - 2] = '\0';
5626 }
5627 else
5628 canon = xstrdup (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)));
5629 return canon;
5630 }
5631
5632 /* The result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list with FULL_SEARCH set
5633 to 1, but choosing the first symbol found if there are multiple
5634 choices.
5635
5636 The result is stored in *INFO, which must be non-NULL.
5637 If no match is found, INFO->SYM is set to NULL. */
5638
5639 void
5640 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block,
5641 domain_enum domain,
5642 struct ada_symbol_info *info)
5643 {
5644 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
5645 int n_candidates;
5646
5647 gdb_assert (info != NULL);
5648 memset (info, 0, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
5649
5650 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block, domain, &candidates);
5651 if (n_candidates == 0)
5652 return;
5653
5654 *info = candidates[0];
5655 info->sym = fixup_symbol_section (info->sym, NULL);
5656 }
5657
5658 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
5659 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
5660 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
5661 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices.
5662 If IS_A_FIELD_OF_THIS is not NULL, it is set to zero. */
5663
5664 struct symbol *
5665 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
5666 domain_enum domain, int *is_a_field_of_this)
5667 {
5668 struct ada_symbol_info info;
5669
5670 if (is_a_field_of_this != NULL)
5671 *is_a_field_of_this = 0;
5672
5673 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)),
5674 block0, domain, &info);
5675 return info.sym;
5676 }
5677
5678 static struct symbol *
5679 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const struct language_defn *langdef,
5680 const char *name,
5681 const struct block *block,
5682 const domain_enum domain)
5683 {
5684 struct symbol *sym;
5685
5686 sym = ada_lookup_symbol (name, block_static_block (block), domain, NULL);
5687 if (sym != NULL)
5688 return sym;
5689
5690 /* If we haven't found a match at this point, try the primitive
5691 types. In other languages, this search is performed before
5692 searching for global symbols in order to short-circuit that
5693 global-symbol search if it happens that the name corresponds
5694 to a primitive type. But we cannot do the same in Ada, because
5695 it is perfectly legitimate for a program to declare a type which
5696 has the same name as a standard type. If looking up a type in
5697 that situation, we have traditionally ignored the primitive type
5698 in favor of user-defined types. This is why, unlike most other
5699 languages, we search the primitive types this late and only after
5700 having searched the global symbols without success. */
5701
5702 if (domain == VAR_DOMAIN)
5703 {
5704 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5705
5706 if (block == NULL)
5707 gdbarch = target_gdbarch ();
5708 else
5709 gdbarch = block_gdbarch (block);
5710 sym = language_lookup_primitive_type_as_symbol (langdef, gdbarch, name);
5711 if (sym != NULL)
5712 return sym;
5713 }
5714
5715 return NULL;
5716 }
5717
5718
5719 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
5720 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
5721 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
5722 are given by any of the regular expressions:
5723
5724 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
5725 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
5726 TKB [subprogram suffix for task bodies]
5727 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
5728 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
5729
5730 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
5731 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
5732 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
5733
5734 static int
5735 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
5736 {
5737 int k;
5738 const char *matching;
5739 const int len = strlen (str);
5740
5741 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
5742
5743 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
5744 {
5745 str += 3;
5746 while (isdigit (str[0]))
5747 str += 1;
5748 }
5749
5750 /* [.$][0-9]+ */
5751
5752 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
5753 {
5754 matching = str + 1;
5755 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5756 matching += 1;
5757 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5758 return 1;
5759 }
5760
5761 /* ___[0-9]+ */
5762
5763 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
5764 {
5765 matching = str + 3;
5766 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5767 matching += 1;
5768 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5769 return 1;
5770 }
5771
5772 /* "TKB" suffixes are used for subprograms implementing task bodies. */
5773
5774 if (strcmp (str, "TKB") == 0)
5775 return 1;
5776
5777 #if 0
5778 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
5779 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
5780 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
5781 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
5782 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
5783 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
5784 name ends with N.
5785 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
5786 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
5787 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
5788 the following check. */
5789 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
5790 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
5791 return 1;
5792 #endif
5793
5794 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */
5795 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
5796 {
5797 matching = str + 3;
5798 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5799 matching += 1;
5800 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
5801 && matching [1] == '\0')
5802 return 1;
5803 }
5804
5805 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
5806 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
5807 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
5808 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
5809 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
5810 if (str[0] == 'X')
5811 {
5812 str += 1;
5813 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
5814 {
5815 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
5816 return 0;
5817 str += 1;
5818 }
5819 }
5820
5821 if (str[0] == '\000')
5822 return 1;
5823
5824 if (str[0] == '_')
5825 {
5826 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
5827 return 0;
5828 if (str[2] == '_')
5829 {
5830 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
5831 return 1;
5832 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
5833 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
5834 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
5835 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
5836 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
5837 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
5838 return 1;
5839 if (str[3] != 'X')
5840 return 0;
5841 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
5842 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
5843 return 1;
5844 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
5845 return 1;
5846 return 0;
5847 }
5848 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
5849 return 0;
5850 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
5851 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
5852 return 0;
5853 return 1;
5854 }
5855 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
5856 {
5857 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
5858 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
5859 return 0;
5860 return 1;
5861 }
5862 return 0;
5863 }
5864
5865 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
5866 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
5867
5868 static int
5869 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
5870 {
5871 const char *decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
5872 int i;
5873
5874 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that
5875 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then
5876 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */
5877 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
5878 return 0;
5879
5880 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
5881 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
5882 return 0;
5883
5884 return 1;
5885 }
5886
5887 /* Advance *NAMEP to next occurrence of TARGET0 in the string NAME0
5888 that could start a simple name. Assumes that *NAMEP points into
5889 the string beginning at NAME0. */
5890
5891 static int
5892 advance_wild_match (const char **namep, const char *name0, int target0)
5893 {
5894 const char *name = *namep;
5895
5896 while (1)
5897 {
5898 int t0, t1;
5899
5900 t0 = *name;
5901 if (t0 == '_')
5902 {
5903 t1 = name[1];
5904 if ((t1 >= 'a' && t1 <= 'z') || (t1 >= '0' && t1 <= '9'))
5905 {
5906 name += 1;
5907 if (name == name0 + 5 && startswith (name0, "_ada"))
5908 break;
5909 else
5910 name += 1;
5911 }
5912 else if (t1 == '_' && ((name[2] >= 'a' && name[2] <= 'z')
5913 || name[2] == target0))
5914 {
5915 name += 2;
5916 break;
5917 }
5918 else
5919 return 0;
5920 }
5921 else if ((t0 >= 'a' && t0 <= 'z') || (t0 >= '0' && t0 <= '9'))
5922 name += 1;
5923 else
5924 return 0;
5925 }
5926
5927 *namep = name;
5928 return 1;
5929 }
5930
5931 /* Return 0 iff NAME encodes a name of the form prefix.PATN. Ignores any
5932 informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which is_name_suffix is
5933 true). Assumes that PATN is a lower-cased Ada simple name. */
5934
5935 static int
5936 wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn)
5937 {
5938 const char *p;
5939 const char *name0 = name;
5940
5941 while (1)
5942 {
5943 const char *match = name;
5944
5945 if (*name == *patn)
5946 {
5947 for (name += 1, p = patn + 1; *p != '\0'; name += 1, p += 1)
5948 if (*p != *name)
5949 break;
5950 if (*p == '\0' && is_name_suffix (name))
5951 return match != name0 && !is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0);
5952
5953 if (name[-1] == '_')
5954 name -= 1;
5955 }
5956 if (!advance_wild_match (&name, name0, *patn))
5957 return 1;
5958 }
5959 }
5960
5961 /* Returns 0 iff symbol name SYM_NAME matches SEARCH_NAME, apart from
5962 informational suffix. */
5963
5964 static int
5965 full_match (const char *sym_name, const char *search_name)
5966 {
5967 return !match_name (sym_name, search_name, 0);
5968 }
5969
5970
5971 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN to
5972 vector *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP
5973 (if necessary). If WILD, treat as NAME with a wildcard prefix.
5974 OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK. */
5975
5976 static void
5977 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5978 const struct block *block, const char *name,
5979 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile,
5980 int wild)
5981 {
5982 struct block_iterator iter;
5983 int name_len = strlen (name);
5984 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
5985 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5986 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
5987 int found_sym;
5988 struct symbol *sym;
5989
5990 arg_sym = NULL;
5991 found_sym = 0;
5992 if (wild)
5993 {
5994 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, name, wild_match, &iter);
5995 sym != NULL; sym = block_iter_match_next (name, wild_match, &iter))
5996 {
5997 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5998 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain)
5999 && wild_match (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), name) == 0)
6000 {
6001 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
6002 continue;
6003 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
6004 arg_sym = sym;
6005 else
6006 {
6007 found_sym = 1;
6008 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6009 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
6010 block);
6011 }
6012 }
6013 }
6014 }
6015 else
6016 {
6017 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, name, full_match, &iter);
6018 sym != NULL; sym = block_iter_match_next (name, full_match, &iter))
6019 {
6020 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
6021 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
6022 {
6023 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
6024 {
6025 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
6026 arg_sym = sym;
6027 else
6028 {
6029 found_sym = 1;
6030 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6031 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
6032 block);
6033 }
6034 }
6035 }
6036 }
6037 }
6038
6039 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
6040 {
6041 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6042 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
6043 block);
6044 }
6045
6046 if (!wild)
6047 {
6048 arg_sym = NULL;
6049 found_sym = 0;
6050
6051 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
6052 {
6053 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
6054 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
6055 {
6056 int cmp;
6057
6058 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)[0];
6059 if (cmp == 0)
6060 {
6061 cmp = !startswith (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "_ada_");
6062 if (cmp == 0)
6063 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + 5,
6064 name_len);
6065 }
6066
6067 if (cmp == 0
6068 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len + 5))
6069 {
6070 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
6071 {
6072 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
6073 arg_sym = sym;
6074 else
6075 {
6076 found_sym = 1;
6077 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6078 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
6079 block);
6080 }
6081 }
6082 }
6083 }
6084 }
6085
6086 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
6087 They aren't parameters, right? */
6088 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
6089 {
6090 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6091 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
6092 block);
6093 }
6094 }
6095 }
6096 \f
6097
6098 /* Symbol Completion */
6099
6100 /* If SYM_NAME is a completion candidate for TEXT, return this symbol
6101 name in a form that's appropriate for the completion. The result
6102 does not need to be deallocated, but is only good until the next call.
6103
6104 TEXT_LEN is equal to the length of TEXT.
6105 Perform a wild match if WILD_MATCH_P is set.
6106 ENCODED_P should be set if TEXT represents the start of a symbol name
6107 in its encoded form. */
6108
6109 static const char *
6110 symbol_completion_match (const char *sym_name,
6111 const char *text, int text_len,
6112 int wild_match_p, int encoded_p)
6113 {
6114 const int verbatim_match = (text[0] == '<');
6115 int match = 0;
6116
6117 if (verbatim_match)
6118 {
6119 /* Strip the leading angle bracket. */
6120 text = text + 1;
6121 text_len--;
6122 }
6123
6124 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
6125
6126 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
6127 match = 1;
6128
6129 if (match && !encoded_p)
6130 {
6131 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
6132 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
6133 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
6134 is not a suitable completion. */
6135 const char *sym_name_copy = sym_name;
6136 int has_angle_bracket;
6137
6138 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
6139 has_angle_bracket = (sym_name[0] == '<');
6140 match = (has_angle_bracket == verbatim_match);
6141 sym_name = sym_name_copy;
6142 }
6143
6144 if (match && !verbatim_match)
6145 {
6146 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
6147 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
6148 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
6149 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
6150 angle bracket notation. */
6151 const char *tmp;
6152
6153 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
6154 if (*tmp != '\0')
6155 match = 0;
6156 }
6157
6158 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
6159
6160 if (!match && wild_match_p)
6161 {
6162 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
6163 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
6164 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
6165 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (ada_decode (sym_name));
6166
6167 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
6168 match = 1;
6169 }
6170
6171 /* Finally: If we found a mach, prepare the result to return. */
6172
6173 if (!match)
6174 return NULL;
6175
6176 if (verbatim_match)
6177 sym_name = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
6178
6179 if (!encoded_p)
6180 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
6181
6182 return sym_name;
6183 }
6184
6185 /* A companion function to ada_make_symbol_completion_list().
6186 Check if SYM_NAME represents a symbol which name would be suitable
6187 to complete TEXT (TEXT_LEN is the length of TEXT), in which case
6188 it is appended at the end of the given string vector SV.
6189
6190 ORIG_TEXT is the string original string from the user command
6191 that needs to be completed. WORD is the entire command on which
6192 completion should be performed. These two parameters are used to
6193 determine which part of the symbol name should be added to the
6194 completion vector.
6195 if WILD_MATCH_P is set, then wild matching is performed.
6196 ENCODED_P should be set if TEXT represents a symbol name in its
6197 encoded formed (in which case the completion should also be
6198 encoded). */
6199
6200 static void
6201 symbol_completion_add (VEC(char_ptr) **sv,
6202 const char *sym_name,
6203 const char *text, int text_len,
6204 const char *orig_text, const char *word,
6205 int wild_match_p, int encoded_p)
6206 {
6207 const char *match = symbol_completion_match (sym_name, text, text_len,
6208 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
6209 char *completion;
6210
6211 if (match == NULL)
6212 return;
6213
6214 /* We found a match, so add the appropriate completion to the given
6215 string vector. */
6216
6217 if (word == orig_text)
6218 {
6219 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
6220 strcpy (completion, match);
6221 }
6222 else if (word > orig_text)
6223 {
6224 /* Return some portion of sym_name. */
6225 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
6226 strcpy (completion, match + (word - orig_text));
6227 }
6228 else
6229 {
6230 /* Return some of ORIG_TEXT plus sym_name. */
6231 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + (orig_text - word) + 5);
6232 strncpy (completion, word, orig_text - word);
6233 completion[orig_text - word] = '\0';
6234 strcat (completion, match);
6235 }
6236
6237 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, *sv, completion);
6238 }
6239
6240 /* An object of this type is passed as the user_data argument to the
6241 expand_symtabs_matching method. */
6242 struct add_partial_datum
6243 {
6244 VEC(char_ptr) **completions;
6245 const char *text;
6246 int text_len;
6247 const char *text0;
6248 const char *word;
6249 int wild_match;
6250 int encoded;
6251 };
6252
6253 /* A callback for expand_symtabs_matching. */
6254
6255 static int
6256 ada_complete_symbol_matcher (const char *name, void *user_data)
6257 {
6258 struct add_partial_datum *data = user_data;
6259
6260 return symbol_completion_match (name, data->text, data->text_len,
6261 data->wild_match, data->encoded) != NULL;
6262 }
6263
6264 /* Return a list of possible symbol names completing TEXT0. WORD is
6265 the entire command on which completion is made. */
6266
6267 static VEC (char_ptr) *
6268 ada_make_symbol_completion_list (const char *text0, const char *word,
6269 enum type_code code)
6270 {
6271 char *text;
6272 int text_len;
6273 int wild_match_p;
6274 int encoded_p;
6275 VEC(char_ptr) *completions = VEC_alloc (char_ptr, 128);
6276 struct symbol *sym;
6277 struct compunit_symtab *s;
6278 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
6279 struct objfile *objfile;
6280 const struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
6281 int i;
6282 struct block_iterator iter;
6283 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
6284
6285 gdb_assert (code == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF);
6286
6287 if (text0[0] == '<')
6288 {
6289 text = xstrdup (text0);
6290 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
6291 text_len = strlen (text);
6292 wild_match_p = 0;
6293 encoded_p = 1;
6294 }
6295 else
6296 {
6297 text = xstrdup (ada_encode (text0));
6298 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
6299 text_len = strlen (text);
6300 for (i = 0; i < text_len; i++)
6301 text[i] = tolower (text[i]);
6302
6303 encoded_p = (strstr (text0, "__") != NULL);
6304 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
6305 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
6306 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks like
6307 an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild mode. */
6308 wild_match_p = (strchr (text0, '.') == NULL && !encoded_p);
6309 }
6310
6311 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
6312 {
6313 struct add_partial_datum data;
6314
6315 data.completions = &completions;
6316 data.text = text;
6317 data.text_len = text_len;
6318 data.text0 = text0;
6319 data.word = word;
6320 data.wild_match = wild_match_p;
6321 data.encoded = encoded_p;
6322 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL, ada_complete_symbol_matcher, NULL,
6323 ALL_DOMAIN, &data);
6324 }
6325
6326 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
6327 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
6328 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
6329 handled by the psymtab code above). */
6330
6331 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
6332 {
6333 QUIT;
6334 symbol_completion_add (&completions, MSYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol),
6335 text, text_len, text0, word, wild_match_p,
6336 encoded_p);
6337 }
6338
6339 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
6340 complete on local vars. */
6341
6342 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
6343 {
6344 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
6345 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
6346
6347 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6348 {
6349 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
6350 text, text_len, text0, word,
6351 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
6352 }
6353 }
6354
6355 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
6356 symbols which match. */
6357
6358 ALL_COMPUNITS (objfile, s)
6359 {
6360 QUIT;
6361 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
6362 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6363 {
6364 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
6365 text, text_len, text0, word,
6366 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
6367 }
6368 }
6369
6370 ALL_COMPUNITS (objfile, s)
6371 {
6372 QUIT;
6373 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
6374 /* Don't do this block twice. */
6375 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
6376 continue;
6377 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6378 {
6379 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
6380 text, text_len, text0, word,
6381 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
6382 }
6383 }
6384
6385 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6386 return completions;
6387 }
6388
6389 /* Field Access */
6390
6391 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
6392 for tagged types. */
6393
6394 static int
6395 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
6396 {
6397 const char *name;
6398
6399 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6400 return 0;
6401
6402 name = TYPE_NAME (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
6403 if (name == NULL)
6404 return 0;
6405
6406 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6407 }
6408
6409 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is an interface tag. */
6410
6411 static int
6412 ada_is_interface_tag (struct type *type)
6413 {
6414 const char *name = TYPE_NAME (type);
6415
6416 if (name == NULL)
6417 return 0;
6418
6419 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__interface_tag") == 0);
6420 }
6421
6422 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
6423 to be invisible to users. */
6424
6425 int
6426 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6427 {
6428 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
6429 return 1;
6430
6431 /* Check the name of that field. */
6432 {
6433 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6434
6435 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
6436 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
6437 but we don't want to print the value of annonymous fields anyway. */
6438 if (name == NULL)
6439 return 1;
6440
6441 /* Normally, fields whose name start with an underscore ("_")
6442 are fields that have been internally generated by the compiler,
6443 and thus should not be printed. The "_parent" field is special,
6444 however: This is a field internally generated by the compiler
6445 for tagged types, and it contains the components inherited from
6446 the parent type. This field should not be printed as is, but
6447 should not be ignored either. */
6448 if (name[0] == '_' && !startswith (name, "_parent"))
6449 return 1;
6450 }
6451
6452 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type or an interface tag,
6453 then ignore. */
6454 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
6455 && (ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num))
6456 || ada_is_interface_tag (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num))))
6457 return 1;
6458
6459 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
6460 return 0;
6461 }
6462
6463 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
6464 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
6465
6466 int
6467 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
6468 {
6469 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1, NULL) != NULL);
6470 }
6471
6472 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
6473
6474 int
6475 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
6476 {
6477 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6478
6479 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6480 return 0;
6481 else
6482 {
6483 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
6484
6485 return (name != NULL
6486 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6487 }
6488 }
6489
6490 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
6491
6492 struct type *
6493 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
6494 {
6495 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0, NULL);
6496 }
6497
6498 /* Return 1 if TAG follows the old scheme for Ada tags (used for Ada 95,
6499 retired at Ada 05). */
6500
6501 static int
6502 is_ada95_tag (struct value *tag)
6503 {
6504 return ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1) != NULL;
6505 }
6506
6507 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
6508
6509 struct value *
6510 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
6511 {
6512 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
6513 }
6514
6515 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
6516 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
6517 ADDRESS. */
6518
6519 static struct value *
6520 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
6521 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6522 CORE_ADDR address)
6523 {
6524 int tag_byte_offset;
6525 struct type *tag_type;
6526
6527 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
6528 NULL, NULL, NULL))
6529 {
6530 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
6531 ? NULL
6532 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
6533 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
6534
6535 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
6536 }
6537 return NULL;
6538 }
6539
6540 static struct type *
6541 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6542 {
6543 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
6544
6545 if (type_name != NULL)
6546 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
6547 return NULL;
6548 }
6549
6550 /* Given a value OBJ of a tagged type, return a value of this
6551 type at the base address of the object. The base address, as
6552 defined in Ada.Tags, it is the address of the primary tag of
6553 the object, and therefore where the field values of its full
6554 view can be fetched. */
6555
6556 struct value *
6557 ada_tag_value_at_base_address (struct value *obj)
6558 {
6559 struct value *val;
6560 LONGEST offset_to_top = 0;
6561 struct type *ptr_type, *obj_type;
6562 struct value *tag;
6563 CORE_ADDR base_address;
6564
6565 obj_type = value_type (obj);
6566
6567 /* It is the responsability of the caller to deref pointers. */
6568
6569 if (TYPE_CODE (obj_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
6570 || TYPE_CODE (obj_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6571 return obj;
6572
6573 tag = ada_value_tag (obj);
6574 if (!tag)
6575 return obj;
6576
6577 /* Base addresses only appeared with Ada 05 and multiple inheritance. */
6578
6579 if (is_ada95_tag (tag))
6580 return obj;
6581
6582 ptr_type = builtin_type (target_gdbarch ())->builtin_data_ptr;
6583 ptr_type = lookup_pointer_type (ptr_type);
6584 val = value_cast (ptr_type, tag);
6585 if (!val)
6586 return obj;
6587
6588 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while
6589 trying to determine the base address, just like for the tag;
6590 see ada_tag_name for more details. We do not print the error
6591 message for the same reason. */
6592
6593 TRY
6594 {
6595 offset_to_top = value_as_long (value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -2)));
6596 }
6597
6598 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
6599 {
6600 return obj;
6601 }
6602 END_CATCH
6603
6604 /* If offset is null, nothing to do. */
6605
6606 if (offset_to_top == 0)
6607 return obj;
6608
6609 /* -1 is a special case in Ada.Tags; however, what should be done
6610 is not quite clear from the documentation. So do nothing for
6611 now. */
6612
6613 if (offset_to_top == -1)
6614 return obj;
6615
6616 base_address = value_address (obj) - offset_to_top;
6617 tag = value_tag_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address);
6618
6619 /* Make sure that we have a proper tag at the new address.
6620 Otherwise, offset_to_top is bogus (which can happen when
6621 the object is not initialized yet). */
6622
6623 if (!tag)
6624 return obj;
6625
6626 obj_type = type_from_tag (tag);
6627
6628 if (!obj_type)
6629 return obj;
6630
6631 return value_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address);
6632 }
6633
6634 /* Return the "ada__tags__type_specific_data" type. */
6635
6636 static struct type *
6637 ada_get_tsd_type (struct inferior *inf)
6638 {
6639 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (inf);
6640
6641 if (data->tsd_type == 0)
6642 data->tsd_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
6643 return data->tsd_type;
6644 }
6645
6646 /* Return the TSD (type-specific data) associated to the given TAG.
6647 TAG is assumed to be the tag of a tagged-type entity.
6648
6649 May return NULL if we are unable to get the TSD. */
6650
6651 static struct value *
6652 ada_get_tsd_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6653 {
6654 struct value *val;
6655 struct type *type;
6656
6657 /* First option: The TSD is simply stored as a field of our TAG.
6658 Only older versions of GNAT would use this format, but we have
6659 to test it first, because there are no visible markers for
6660 the current approach except the absence of that field. */
6661
6662 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1);
6663 if (val)
6664 return val;
6665
6666 /* Try the second representation for the dispatch table (in which
6667 there is no explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer,
6668 and instead the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch
6669 table. */
6670
6671 type = ada_get_tsd_type (current_inferior());
6672 if (type == NULL)
6673 return NULL;
6674 type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (type));
6675 val = value_cast (type, tag);
6676 if (val == NULL)
6677 return NULL;
6678 return value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -1));
6679 }
6680
6681 /* Given the TSD of a tag (type-specific data), return a string
6682 containing the name of the associated type.
6683
6684 The returned value is good until the next call. May return NULL
6685 if we are unable to determine the tag name. */
6686
6687 static char *
6688 ada_tag_name_from_tsd (struct value *tsd)
6689 {
6690 static char name[1024];
6691 char *p;
6692 struct value *val;
6693
6694 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tsd, "expanded_name", 1);
6695 if (val == NULL)
6696 return NULL;
6697 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
6698 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
6699 if (isalpha (*p))
6700 *p = tolower (*p);
6701 return name;
6702 }
6703
6704 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
6705 a C string.
6706
6707 Return NULL if the TAG is not an Ada tag, or if we were unable to
6708 determine the name of that tag. The result is good until the next
6709 call. */
6710
6711 const char *
6712 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
6713 {
6714 char *name = NULL;
6715
6716 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
6717 return NULL;
6718
6719 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while trying
6720 to determine the TAG's name, even under normal circumstances:
6721 The associated variable may be uninitialized or corrupted, for
6722 instance. We do not let any exception propagate past this point.
6723 instead we return NULL.
6724
6725 We also do not print the error message either (which often is very
6726 low-level (Eg: "Cannot read memory at 0x[...]"), but instead let
6727 the caller print a more meaningful message if necessary. */
6728 TRY
6729 {
6730 struct value *tsd = ada_get_tsd_from_tag (tag);
6731
6732 if (tsd != NULL)
6733 name = ada_tag_name_from_tsd (tsd);
6734 }
6735 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
6736 {
6737 }
6738 END_CATCH
6739
6740 return name;
6741 }
6742
6743 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
6744
6745 struct type *
6746 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
6747 {
6748 int i;
6749
6750 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6751
6752 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6753 return NULL;
6754
6755 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6756 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
6757 {
6758 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6759
6760 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */
6761 if (TYPE_CODE (parent_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6762 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type);
6763 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */
6764 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type);
6765
6766 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type);
6767 }
6768
6769 return NULL;
6770 }
6771
6772 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
6773 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
6774 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6775
6776 int
6777 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6778 {
6779 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
6780
6781 return (name != NULL
6782 && (startswith (name, "PARENT")
6783 || startswith (name, "_parent")));
6784 }
6785
6786 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
6787 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
6788 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
6789 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
6790 structures. */
6791
6792 int
6793 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6794 {
6795 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6796
6797 return (name != NULL
6798 && (startswith (name, "PARENT")
6799 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
6800 || startswith (name, "_parent")
6801 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
6802 }
6803
6804 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
6805 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
6806 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6807
6808 int
6809 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
6810 {
6811 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
6812
6813 return (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
6814 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
6815 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type))
6816 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
6817 }
6818
6819 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
6820 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
6821 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant.
6822 May return NULL if the type could not be found. */
6823
6824 struct type *
6825 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6826 {
6827 char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6828
6829 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1, NULL);
6830 }
6831
6832 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
6833 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
6834 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
6835
6836 int
6837 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
6838 {
6839 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6840
6841 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
6842 }
6843
6844 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
6845 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
6846 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
6847
6848 char *
6849 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
6850 {
6851 static char *result = NULL;
6852 static size_t result_len = 0;
6853 struct type *type;
6854 const char *name;
6855 const char *discrim_end;
6856 const char *discrim_start;
6857
6858 if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6859 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
6860 else
6861 type = type0;
6862
6863 name = ada_type_name (type);
6864
6865 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
6866 return "";
6867
6868 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
6869 discrim_end -= 1)
6870 {
6871 if (startswith (discrim_end, "___XVN"))
6872 break;
6873 }
6874 if (discrim_end == name)
6875 return "";
6876
6877 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
6878 discrim_start -= 1)
6879 {
6880 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
6881 return "";
6882 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
6883 && startswith (discrim_start - 3, "___"))
6884 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
6885 break;
6886 }
6887
6888 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
6889 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
6890 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
6891 return result;
6892 }
6893
6894 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
6895 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
6896 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
6897 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
6898 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
6899 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
6900 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
6901
6902 int
6903 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
6904 {
6905 ULONGEST RU;
6906
6907 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
6908 return 0;
6909
6910 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
6911 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
6912 LONGEST. */
6913 RU = 0;
6914 while (isdigit (str[k]))
6915 {
6916 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
6917 k += 1;
6918 }
6919
6920 if (str[k] == 'm')
6921 {
6922 if (R != NULL)
6923 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
6924 k += 1;
6925 }
6926 else if (R != NULL)
6927 *R = (LONGEST) RU;
6928
6929 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
6930 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
6931 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
6932 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
6933 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
6934
6935 if (new_k != NULL)
6936 *new_k = k;
6937 return 1;
6938 }
6939
6940 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
6941 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
6942 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
6943
6944 int
6945 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
6946 {
6947 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6948 int p;
6949
6950 p = 0;
6951 while (1)
6952 {
6953 switch (name[p])
6954 {
6955 case '\0':
6956 return 0;
6957 case 'S':
6958 {
6959 LONGEST W;
6960
6961 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
6962 return 0;
6963 if (val == W)
6964 return 1;
6965 break;
6966 }
6967 case 'R':
6968 {
6969 LONGEST L, U;
6970
6971 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
6972 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
6973 return 0;
6974 if (val >= L && val <= U)
6975 return 1;
6976 break;
6977 }
6978 case 'O':
6979 return 1;
6980 default:
6981 return 0;
6982 }
6983 }
6984 }
6985
6986 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
6987
6988 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
6989 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
6990 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
6991 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
6992
6993 static struct value *
6994 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
6995 struct type *arg_type)
6996 {
6997 struct type *type;
6998
6999 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
7000 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
7001
7002 /* Handle packed fields. */
7003
7004 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0)
7005 {
7006 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
7007 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
7008
7009 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
7010 offset + bit_pos / 8,
7011 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
7012 }
7013 else
7014 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
7015 }
7016
7017 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
7018 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
7019 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
7020 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
7021 an object of that type;
7022 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
7023 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
7024 0 otherwise;
7025 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
7026 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
7027 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
7028 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
7029
7030 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
7031
7032 static int
7033 find_struct_field (const char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
7034 struct type **field_type_p,
7035 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
7036 int *index_p)
7037 {
7038 int i;
7039
7040 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7041
7042 if (field_type_p != NULL)
7043 *field_type_p = NULL;
7044 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
7045 *byte_offset_p = 0;
7046 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
7047 *bit_offset_p = 0;
7048 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
7049 *bit_size_p = 0;
7050
7051 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7052 {
7053 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
7054 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
7055 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7056
7057 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7058 continue;
7059
7060 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7061 {
7062 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
7063
7064 if (field_type_p != NULL)
7065 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
7066 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
7067 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
7068 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
7069 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
7070 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
7071 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
7072 return 1;
7073 }
7074 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7075 {
7076 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
7077 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
7078 bit_size_p, index_p))
7079 return 1;
7080 }
7081 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7082 {
7083 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
7084 fixed type?? */
7085 int j;
7086 struct type *field_type
7087 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7088
7089 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
7090 {
7091 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
7092 fld_offset
7093 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
7094 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
7095 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
7096 return 1;
7097 }
7098 }
7099 else if (index_p != NULL)
7100 *index_p += 1;
7101 }
7102 return 0;
7103 }
7104
7105 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
7106
7107 static int
7108 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
7109 {
7110 int n;
7111
7112 n = 0;
7113 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
7114 return n;
7115 }
7116
7117 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
7118 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
7119 If found, return value, else return NULL.
7120
7121 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent'). */
7122
7123 static struct value *
7124 ada_search_struct_field (char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
7125 struct type *type)
7126 {
7127 int i;
7128
7129 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7130 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7131 {
7132 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7133
7134 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7135 continue;
7136
7137 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7138 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
7139
7140 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7141 {
7142 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
7143 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
7144 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
7145 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7146
7147 if (v != NULL)
7148 return v;
7149 }
7150
7151 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7152 {
7153 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
7154 int j;
7155 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
7156 i));
7157 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
7158
7159 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
7160 {
7161 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line
7162 break. */
7163 (name, arg,
7164 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
7165 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
7166
7167 if (v != NULL)
7168 return v;
7169 }
7170 }
7171 }
7172 return NULL;
7173 }
7174
7175 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
7176 int, struct type *);
7177
7178
7179 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
7180 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
7181 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
7182 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
7183
7184 static struct value *
7185 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
7186 struct type *type)
7187 {
7188 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
7189 }
7190
7191
7192 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
7193 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
7194 * *INDEX_P. */
7195
7196 static struct value *
7197 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
7198 struct type *type)
7199 {
7200 int i;
7201 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7202
7203 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7204 {
7205 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
7206 continue;
7207 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7208 {
7209 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
7210 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
7211 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
7212 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7213
7214 if (v != NULL)
7215 return v;
7216 }
7217
7218 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7219 {
7220 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
7221 find_struct_field. */
7222 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
7223 }
7224 else if (*index_p == 0)
7225 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
7226 else
7227 *index_p -= 1;
7228 }
7229 return NULL;
7230 }
7231
7232 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
7233 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
7234 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
7235 appropriate type.
7236
7237 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
7238 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
7239 (e.g., '_parent').
7240
7241 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
7242 calling error. */
7243
7244 struct value *
7245 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, char *name, int no_err)
7246 {
7247 struct type *t, *t1;
7248 struct value *v;
7249
7250 v = NULL;
7251 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
7252 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
7253 {
7254 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
7255 if (t1 == NULL)
7256 goto BadValue;
7257 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
7258 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
7259 {
7260 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
7261 t = t1;
7262 }
7263 }
7264
7265 while (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
7266 {
7267 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
7268 if (t1 == NULL)
7269 goto BadValue;
7270 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
7271 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
7272 {
7273 arg = value_ind (arg);
7274 t = t1;
7275 }
7276 else
7277 break;
7278 }
7279
7280 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
7281 goto BadValue;
7282
7283 if (t1 == t)
7284 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
7285 else
7286 {
7287 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
7288 struct type *field_type;
7289 CORE_ADDR address;
7290
7291 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
7292 address = value_address (ada_value_ind (arg));
7293 else
7294 address = value_address (ada_coerce_ref (arg));
7295
7296 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL, address, NULL, 1);
7297 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
7298 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
7299 &bit_size, NULL))
7300 {
7301 if (bit_size != 0)
7302 {
7303 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
7304 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
7305 else
7306 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
7307 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
7308 bit_offset, bit_size,
7309 field_type);
7310 }
7311 else
7312 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset);
7313 }
7314 }
7315
7316 if (v != NULL || no_err)
7317 return v;
7318 else
7319 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
7320
7321 BadValue:
7322 if (no_err)
7323 return NULL;
7324 else
7325 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of "
7326 "a value that is not a record."));
7327 }
7328
7329 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
7330 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
7331 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
7332 work for packed fields).
7333
7334 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
7335 followed by "___".
7336
7337 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
7338 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
7339 ultimate target type will be searched.
7340
7341 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
7342
7343 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
7344 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
7345
7346 static struct type *
7347 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, char *name, int refok,
7348 int noerr, int *dispp)
7349 {
7350 int i;
7351
7352 if (name == NULL)
7353 goto BadName;
7354
7355 if (refok && type != NULL)
7356 while (1)
7357 {
7358 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7359 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
7360 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
7361 break;
7362 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
7363 }
7364
7365 if (type == NULL
7366 || (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7367 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
7368 {
7369 if (noerr)
7370 return NULL;
7371 else
7372 {
7373 target_terminal_ours ();
7374 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
7375 if (type == NULL)
7376 error (_("Type (null) is not a structure or union type"));
7377 else
7378 {
7379 /* XXX: type_sprint */
7380 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
7381 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
7382 error (_(" is not a structure or union type"));
7383 }
7384 }
7385 }
7386
7387 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7388
7389 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7390 {
7391 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7392 struct type *t;
7393 int disp;
7394
7395 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7396 continue;
7397
7398 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7399 {
7400 if (dispp != NULL)
7401 *dispp += TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
7402 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
7403 }
7404
7405 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7406 {
7407 disp = 0;
7408 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
7409 0, 1, &disp);
7410 if (t != NULL)
7411 {
7412 if (dispp != NULL)
7413 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
7414 return t;
7415 }
7416 }
7417
7418 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7419 {
7420 int j;
7421 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
7422 i));
7423
7424 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
7425 {
7426 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is
7427 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes
7428 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit
7429 if the compiler changes this practice. */
7430 const char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j);
7431 disp = 0;
7432 if (v_field_name != NULL
7433 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name))
7434 t = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j);
7435 else
7436 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type,
7437 j),
7438 name, 0, 1, &disp);
7439
7440 if (t != NULL)
7441 {
7442 if (dispp != NULL)
7443 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
7444 return t;
7445 }
7446 }
7447 }
7448
7449 }
7450
7451 BadName:
7452 if (!noerr)
7453 {
7454 target_terminal_ours ();
7455 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
7456 if (name == NULL)
7457 {
7458 /* XXX: type_sprint */
7459 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
7460 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
7461 error (_(" has no component named <null>"));
7462 }
7463 else
7464 {
7465 /* XXX: type_sprint */
7466 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
7467 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
7468 error (_(" has no component named %s"), name);
7469 }
7470 }
7471
7472 return NULL;
7473 }
7474
7475 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
7476 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE
7477 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a
7478 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */
7479
7480 static int
7481 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
7482 {
7483 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
7484
7485 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1, NULL)
7486 == NULL);
7487 }
7488
7489
7490 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
7491 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE that is stored in GDB at
7492 OUTER_VALADDR, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
7493 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
7494
7495 int
7496 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type,
7497 const gdb_byte *outer_valaddr)
7498 {
7499 int others_clause;
7500 int i;
7501 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
7502 struct value *outer;
7503 struct value *discrim;
7504 LONGEST discrim_val;
7505
7506 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here causes problems
7507 because we will end up trying to resolve a type that is currently
7508 being constructed. */
7509 outer = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (outer_type,
7510 outer_valaddr, 0);
7511 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
7512 if (discrim == NULL)
7513 return -1;
7514 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
7515
7516 others_clause = -1;
7517 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1)
7518 {
7519 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
7520 others_clause = i;
7521 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
7522 return i;
7523 }
7524
7525 return others_clause;
7526 }
7527 \f
7528
7529
7530 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
7531
7532 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
7533 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
7534 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
7535 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
7536 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
7537
7538 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
7539 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
7540 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
7541 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
7542 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
7543 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
7544 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
7545 rather than struct value*s.
7546
7547 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
7548 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
7549 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
7550 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
7551 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
7552 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
7553 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
7554 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
7555 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
7556 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
7557 element selected. */
7558
7559 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
7560 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
7561 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
7562 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
7563 target at the target address. */
7564
7565 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
7566 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
7567 dynamic-sized types. */
7568
7569 struct value *
7570 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
7571 {
7572 struct value *val = value_ind (val0);
7573
7574 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0))
7575 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val);
7576
7577 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7578 }
7579
7580 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
7581 qualifiers on VAL0. */
7582
7583 static struct value *
7584 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
7585 {
7586 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val0)) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
7587 {
7588 struct value *val = val0;
7589
7590 val = coerce_ref (val);
7591
7592 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0))
7593 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val);
7594
7595 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7596 }
7597 else
7598 return val0;
7599 }
7600
7601 /* Return OFF rounded upward if necessary to a multiple of
7602 ALIGNMENT (a power of 2). */
7603
7604 static unsigned int
7605 align_value (unsigned int off, unsigned int alignment)
7606 {
7607 return (off + alignment - 1) & ~(alignment - 1);
7608 }
7609
7610 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
7611
7612 static unsigned int
7613 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
7614 {
7615 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7616 int len;
7617 int align_offset;
7618
7619 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
7620 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
7621 require any alignment. */
7622 if (name == NULL)
7623 return 1;
7624
7625 len = strlen (name);
7626
7627 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
7628 return 1;
7629
7630 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
7631 align_offset = len - 2;
7632 else
7633 align_offset = len - 1;
7634
7635 if (align_offset < 7 || !startswith (name + align_offset - 6, "___XV"))
7636 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7637
7638 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7639 }
7640
7641 /* Find a typedef or tag symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
7642
7643 static struct symbol *
7644 ada_find_any_type_symbol (const char *name)
7645 {
7646 struct symbol *sym;
7647
7648 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
7649 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
7650 return sym;
7651
7652 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
7653 return sym;
7654 }
7655
7656 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. This routine will look
7657 solely for types defined by debug info, it will not search the GDB
7658 primitive types. */
7659
7660 static struct type *
7661 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
7662 {
7663 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name);
7664
7665 if (sym != NULL)
7666 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
7667
7668 return NULL;
7669 }
7670
7671 /* Given NAME_SYM and an associated BLOCK, find a "renaming" symbol
7672 associated with NAME_SYM's name. NAME_SYM may itself be a renaming
7673 symbol, in which case it is returned. Otherwise, this looks for
7674 symbols whose name is that of NAME_SYM suffixed with "___XR".
7675 Return symbol if found, and NULL otherwise. */
7676
7677 struct symbol *
7678 ada_find_renaming_symbol (struct symbol *name_sym, const struct block *block)
7679 {
7680 const char *name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (name_sym);
7681 struct symbol *sym;
7682
7683 if (strstr (name, "___XR") != NULL)
7684 return name_sym;
7685
7686 sym = find_old_style_renaming_symbol (name, block);
7687
7688 if (sym != NULL)
7689 return sym;
7690
7691 /* Not right yet. FIXME pnh 7/20/2007. */
7692 sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name);
7693 if (sym != NULL && strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR") != NULL)
7694 return sym;
7695 else
7696 return NULL;
7697 }
7698
7699 static struct symbol *
7700 find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block)
7701 {
7702 const struct symbol *function_sym = block_linkage_function (block);
7703 char *rename;
7704
7705 if (function_sym != NULL)
7706 {
7707 /* If the symbol is defined inside a function, NAME is not fully
7708 qualified. This means we need to prepend the function name
7709 as well as adding the ``___XR'' suffix to build the name of
7710 the associated renaming symbol. */
7711 const char *function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (function_sym);
7712 /* Function names sometimes contain suffixes used
7713 for instance to qualify nested subprograms. When building
7714 the XR type name, we need to make sure that this suffix is
7715 not included. So do not include any suffix in the function
7716 name length below. */
7717 int function_name_len = ada_name_prefix_len (function_name);
7718 const int rename_len = function_name_len + 2 /* "__" */
7719 + strlen (name) + 6 /* "___XR\0" */ ;
7720
7721 /* Strip the suffix if necessary. */
7722 ada_remove_trailing_digits (function_name, &function_name_len);
7723 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
7724 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
7725
7726 /* Library-level functions are a special case, as GNAT adds
7727 a ``_ada_'' prefix to the function name to avoid namespace
7728 pollution. However, the renaming symbols themselves do not
7729 have this prefix, so we need to skip this prefix if present. */
7730 if (function_name_len > 5 /* "_ada_" */
7731 && strstr (function_name, "_ada_") == function_name)
7732 {
7733 function_name += 5;
7734 function_name_len -= 5;
7735 }
7736
7737 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
7738 strncpy (rename, function_name, function_name_len);
7739 xsnprintf (rename + function_name_len, rename_len - function_name_len,
7740 "__%s___XR", name);
7741 }
7742 else
7743 {
7744 const int rename_len = strlen (name) + 6;
7745
7746 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
7747 xsnprintf (rename, rename_len * sizeof (char), "%s___XR", name);
7748 }
7749
7750 return ada_find_any_type_symbol (rename);
7751 }
7752
7753 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
7754 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
7755 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
7756 otherwise return 0. */
7757
7758 int
7759 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
7760 {
7761 if (type1 == NULL)
7762 return 1;
7763 else if (type0 == NULL)
7764 return 0;
7765 else if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7766 return 1;
7767 else if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7768 return 0;
7769 else if (TYPE_NAME (type1) == NULL && TYPE_NAME (type0) != NULL)
7770 return 1;
7771 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0))
7772 return 1;
7773 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
7774 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
7775 return 1;
7776 else
7777 {
7778 const char *type0_name = type_name_no_tag (type0);
7779 const char *type1_name = type_name_no_tag (type1);
7780
7781 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
7782 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
7783 return 1;
7784 }
7785 return 0;
7786 }
7787
7788 /* The name of TYPE, which is either its TYPE_NAME, or, if that is
7789 null, its TYPE_TAG_NAME. Null if TYPE is null. */
7790
7791 const char *
7792 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
7793 {
7794 if (type == NULL)
7795 return NULL;
7796 else if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL)
7797 return TYPE_NAME (type);
7798 else
7799 return TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
7800 }
7801
7802 /* Search the list of "descriptive" types associated to TYPE for a type
7803 whose name is NAME. */
7804
7805 static struct type *
7806 find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (struct type *type, const char *name)
7807 {
7808 struct type *result, *tmp;
7809
7810 if (ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p)
7811 return NULL;
7812
7813 /* If there no descriptive-type info, then there is no parallel type
7814 to be found. */
7815 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7816 return NULL;
7817
7818 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (type);
7819 while (result != NULL)
7820 {
7821 const char *result_name = ada_type_name (result);
7822
7823 if (result_name == NULL)
7824 {
7825 warning (_("unexpected null name on descriptive type"));
7826 return NULL;
7827 }
7828
7829 /* If the names match, stop. */
7830 if (strcmp (result_name, name) == 0)
7831 break;
7832
7833 /* Otherwise, look at the next item on the list, if any. */
7834 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7835 tmp = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7836 else
7837 tmp = NULL;
7838
7839 /* If not found either, try after having resolved the typedef. */
7840 if (tmp != NULL)
7841 result = tmp;
7842 else
7843 {
7844 CHECK_TYPEDEF (result);
7845 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7846 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7847 else
7848 result = NULL;
7849 }
7850 }
7851
7852 /* If we didn't find a match, see whether this is a packed array. With
7853 older compilers, the descriptive type information is either absent or
7854 irrelevant when it comes to packed arrays so the above lookup fails.
7855 Fall back to using a parallel lookup by name in this case. */
7856 if (result == NULL && ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
7857 return ada_find_any_type (name);
7858
7859 return result;
7860 }
7861
7862 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE with the specified NAME, using the
7863 descriptive type taken from the debugging information, if available,
7864 and otherwise using the (slower) name-based method. */
7865
7866 static struct type *
7867 ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *type, const char *name)
7868 {
7869 struct type *result = NULL;
7870
7871 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7872 result = find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (type, name);
7873 else
7874 result = ada_find_any_type (name);
7875
7876 return result;
7877 }
7878
7879 /* Same as above, but specify the name of the parallel type by appending
7880 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
7881
7882 struct type *
7883 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
7884 {
7885 char *name;
7886 const char *type_name = ada_type_name (type);
7887 int len;
7888
7889 if (type_name == NULL)
7890 return NULL;
7891
7892 len = strlen (type_name);
7893
7894 name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
7895
7896 strcpy (name, type_name);
7897 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
7898
7899 return ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
7900 }
7901
7902 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
7903 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
7904
7905 static struct type *
7906 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
7907 {
7908 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7909
7910 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7911 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
7912 return NULL;
7913 else
7914 {
7915 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
7916
7917 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
7918 return type;
7919 else
7920 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
7921 }
7922 }
7923
7924 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
7925 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
7926
7927 static int
7928 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
7929 {
7930 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
7931
7932 return name != NULL
7933 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
7934 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
7935 }
7936
7937 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
7938 represent a variant record type. */
7939
7940 static int
7941 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
7942 {
7943 int f;
7944
7945 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
7946 return -1;
7947
7948 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1)
7949 {
7950 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
7951 return f;
7952 }
7953 return -1;
7954 }
7955
7956 /* A record type with no fields. */
7957
7958 static struct type *
7959 empty_record (struct type *templ)
7960 {
7961 struct type *type = alloc_type_copy (templ);
7962
7963 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7964 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = 0;
7965 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL;
7966 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7967 TYPE_NAME (type) = "<empty>";
7968 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7969 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7970 return type;
7971 }
7972
7973 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7974 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
7975 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
7976 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
7977 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
7978 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
7979 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
7980 of the variant.
7981
7982 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
7983 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
7984 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
7985
7986 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
7987 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
7988 byte-aligned. */
7989
7990 struct type *
7991 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
7992 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7993 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
7994 int keep_dynamic_fields)
7995 {
7996 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7997 struct value *dval;
7998 struct type *rtype;
7999 int nfields, bit_len;
8000 int variant_field;
8001 long off;
8002 int fld_bit_len;
8003 int f;
8004
8005 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
8006 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
8007 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
8008 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
8009 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
8010 else
8011 {
8012 nfields = 0;
8013 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type)
8014 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
8015 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
8016 nfields++;
8017 }
8018
8019 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
8020 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
8021 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
8022 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
8023 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *)
8024 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
8025 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8026 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
8027 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
8028 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
8029
8030 off = 0;
8031 bit_len = 0;
8032 variant_field = -1;
8033
8034 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
8035 {
8036 off = align_value (off, field_alignment (type, f))
8037 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
8038 SET_FIELD_BITPOS (TYPE_FIELD (rtype, f), off);
8039 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
8040
8041 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
8042 {
8043 variant_field = f;
8044 fld_bit_len = 0;
8045 }
8046 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
8047 {
8048 const gdb_byte *field_valaddr = valaddr;
8049 CORE_ADDR field_address = address;
8050 struct type *field_type =
8051 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f));
8052
8053 if (dval0 == NULL)
8054 {
8055 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time
8056 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not
8057 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and
8058 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the
8059 size first before creating the value. */
8060 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (rtype);
8061 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here
8062 causes problems because we will end up trying to
8063 resolve a type that is currently being
8064 constructed. */
8065 dval = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (rtype,
8066 valaddr,
8067 address);
8068 rtype = value_type (dval);
8069 }
8070 else
8071 dval = dval0;
8072
8073 /* If the type referenced by this field is an aligner type, we need
8074 to unwrap that aligner type, because its size might not be set.
8075 Keeping the aligner type would cause us to compute the wrong
8076 size for this field, impacting the offset of the all the fields
8077 that follow this one. */
8078 if (ada_is_aligner_type (field_type))
8079 {
8080 long field_offset = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, f);
8081
8082 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, field_offset);
8083 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, field_offset);
8084 field_type = ada_aligned_type (field_type);
8085 }
8086
8087 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr,
8088 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8089 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address,
8090 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8091
8092 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case,
8093 we do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if
8094 the current field is the parent part of a tagged record,
8095 we will get the tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real
8096 type of the parent is not the real type of the child. We
8097 would end up in an infinite loop. */
8098 field_type = ada_get_base_type (field_type);
8099 field_type = ada_to_fixed_type (field_type, field_valaddr,
8100 field_address, dval, 0);
8101 /* If the field size is already larger than the maximum
8102 object size, then the record itself will necessarily
8103 be larger than the maximum object size. We need to make
8104 this check now, because the size might be so ridiculously
8105 large (due to an uninitialized variable in the inferior)
8106 that it would cause an overflow when adding it to the
8107 record size. */
8108 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (field_type);
8109
8110 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type;
8111 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
8112 /* The multiplication can potentially overflow. But because
8113 the field length has been size-checked just above, and
8114 assuming that the maximum size is a reasonable value,
8115 an overflow should not happen in practice. So rather than
8116 adding overflow recovery code to this already complex code,
8117 we just assume that it's not going to happen. */
8118 fld_bit_len =
8119 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8120 }
8121 else
8122 {
8123 /* Note: If this field's type is a typedef, it is important
8124 to preserve the typedef layer.
8125
8126 Otherwise, we might be transforming a typedef to a fat
8127 pointer (encoding a pointer to an unconstrained array),
8128 into a basic fat pointer (encoding an unconstrained
8129 array). As both types are implemented using the same
8130 structure, the typedef is the only clue which allows us
8131 to distinguish between the two options. Stripping it
8132 would prevent us from printing this field appropriately. */
8133 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
8134 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
8135 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
8136 fld_bit_len =
8137 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
8138 else
8139 {
8140 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
8141
8142 /* We need to be careful of typedefs when computing
8143 the length of our field. If this is a typedef,
8144 get the length of the target type, not the length
8145 of the typedef. */
8146 if (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
8147 field_type = ada_typedef_target_type (field_type);
8148
8149 fld_bit_len =
8150 TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (field_type)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8151 }
8152 }
8153 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
8154 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
8155 off += fld_bit_len;
8156 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
8157 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8158 }
8159
8160 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
8161 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of
8162 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
8163 clauses. */
8164 if (variant_field >= 0)
8165 {
8166 struct type *branch_type;
8167
8168 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
8169
8170 if (dval0 == NULL)
8171 {
8172 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here causes
8173 problems because we will end up trying to resolve a type
8174 that is currently being constructed. */
8175 dval = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (rtype, valaddr,
8176 address);
8177 rtype = value_type (dval);
8178 }
8179 else
8180 dval = dval0;
8181
8182 branch_type =
8183 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
8184 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
8185 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
8186 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
8187 if (branch_type == NULL)
8188 {
8189 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1)
8190 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
8191 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
8192 }
8193 else
8194 {
8195 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
8196 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
8197 fld_bit_len =
8198 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
8199 TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8200 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
8201 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
8202 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
8203 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8204 }
8205 }
8206
8207 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
8208 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
8209 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
8210 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
8211 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
8212 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
8213 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
8214 {
8215 if (TYPE_NAME (rtype))
8216 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %d."),
8217 TYPE_NAME (rtype), TYPE_LENGTH (type));
8218 else
8219 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %d."),
8220 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
8221 }
8222 else
8223 {
8224 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_value (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
8225 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
8226 }
8227
8228 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8229 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
8230 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
8231 return rtype;
8232 }
8233
8234 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
8235 of 1. */
8236
8237 static struct type *
8238 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8239 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
8240 {
8241 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
8242 address, dval0, 1);
8243 }
8244
8245 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
8246 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
8247 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
8248 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
8249 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
8250 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
8251 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
8252 template type. */
8253
8254 static struct type *
8255 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8256 {
8257 struct type *type;
8258 int nfields;
8259 int f;
8260
8261 /* No need no do anything if the input type is already fixed. */
8262 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8263 return type0;
8264
8265 /* Likewise if we already have computed the static approximation. */
8266 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
8267 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
8268
8269 /* Don't clone TYPE0 until we are sure we are going to need a copy. */
8270 type = type0;
8271 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0);
8272
8273 /* Whether or not we cloned TYPE0, cache the result so that we don't do
8274 recompute all over next time. */
8275 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type;
8276
8277 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
8278 {
8279 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f);
8280 struct type *new_type;
8281
8282 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
8283 {
8284 field_type = ada_check_typedef (field_type);
8285 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
8286 }
8287 else
8288 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
8289
8290 if (new_type != field_type)
8291 {
8292 /* Clone TYPE0 only the first time we get a new field type. */
8293 if (type == type0)
8294 {
8295 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type_copy (type0);
8296 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE (type0);
8297 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
8298 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = nfields;
8299 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *)
8300 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
8301 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0),
8302 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8303 TYPE_NAME (type) = ada_type_name (type0);
8304 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
8305 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1;
8306 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
8307 }
8308 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
8309 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
8310 }
8311 }
8312
8313 return type;
8314 }
8315
8316 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
8317 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE,
8318 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant
8319 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
8320 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
8321 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
8322
8323 static struct type *
8324 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8325 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
8326 {
8327 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8328 struct value *dval;
8329 struct type *rtype;
8330 struct type *branch_type;
8331 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
8332 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
8333
8334 if (variant_field == -1)
8335 return type;
8336
8337 if (dval0 == NULL)
8338 {
8339 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
8340 type = value_type (dval);
8341 }
8342 else
8343 dval = dval0;
8344
8345 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
8346 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
8347 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
8348 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
8349 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) =
8350 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
8351 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type),
8352 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8353 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
8354 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
8355 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
8356 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
8357
8358 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
8359 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
8360 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
8361 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
8362 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
8363 cond_offset_target (address,
8364 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
8365 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
8366 if (branch_type == NULL)
8367 {
8368 int f;
8369
8370 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
8371 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
8372 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
8373 }
8374 else
8375 {
8376 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
8377 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
8378 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
8379 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
8380 }
8381 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
8382
8383 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8384 return rtype;
8385 }
8386
8387 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8388 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
8389 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
8390 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
8391 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
8392 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
8393 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
8394 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
8395 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
8396
8397 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
8398 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
8399 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
8400 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
8401 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
8402 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
8403 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
8404
8405 static struct type *
8406 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8407 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
8408 {
8409 struct type *templ_type;
8410
8411 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8412 return type0;
8413
8414 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8415
8416 if (templ_type != NULL)
8417 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
8418 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
8419 {
8420 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
8421 return type0;
8422 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
8423 dval);
8424 }
8425 else
8426 {
8427 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1;
8428 return type0;
8429 }
8430
8431 }
8432
8433 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8434 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
8435 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
8436 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
8437 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
8438 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if
8439 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */
8440
8441 static struct type *
8442 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8443 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
8444 {
8445 int which;
8446 struct type *templ_type;
8447 struct type *var_type;
8448
8449 if (TYPE_CODE (var_type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8450 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
8451 else
8452 var_type = var_type0;
8453
8454 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
8455
8456 if (templ_type != NULL)
8457 var_type = templ_type;
8458
8459 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval)))
8460 return var_type0;
8461 which =
8462 ada_which_variant_applies (var_type,
8463 value_type (dval), value_contents (dval));
8464
8465 if (which < 0)
8466 return empty_record (var_type);
8467 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
8468 return to_fixed_record_type
8469 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
8470 valaddr, address, dval);
8471 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
8472 return
8473 to_fixed_record_type
8474 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
8475 else
8476 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
8477 }
8478
8479 /* Assuming RANGE_TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_RANGE, return nonzero if
8480 ENCODING_TYPE, a type following the GNAT conventions for discrete
8481 type encodings, only carries redundant information. */
8482
8483 static int
8484 ada_is_redundant_range_encoding (struct type *range_type,
8485 struct type *encoding_type)
8486 {
8487 struct type *fixed_range_type;
8488 char *bounds_str;
8489 int n;
8490 LONGEST lo, hi;
8491
8492 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (range_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE);
8493
8494 if (TYPE_CODE (get_base_type (range_type))
8495 != TYPE_CODE (get_base_type (encoding_type)))
8496 {
8497 /* The compiler probably used a simple base type to describe
8498 the range type instead of the range's actual base type,
8499 expecting us to get the real base type from the encoding
8500 anyway. In this situation, the encoding cannot be ignored
8501 as redundant. */
8502 return 0;
8503 }
8504
8505 if (is_dynamic_type (range_type))
8506 return 0;
8507
8508 if (TYPE_NAME (encoding_type) == NULL)
8509 return 0;
8510
8511 bounds_str = strstr (TYPE_NAME (encoding_type), "___XDLU_");
8512 if (bounds_str == NULL)
8513 return 0;
8514
8515 n = 8; /* Skip "___XDLU_". */
8516 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &lo, &n))
8517 return 0;
8518 if (TYPE_LOW_BOUND (range_type) != lo)
8519 return 0;
8520
8521 n += 2; /* Skip the "__" separator between the two bounds. */
8522 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &hi, &n))
8523 return 0;
8524 if (TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (range_type) != hi)
8525 return 0;
8526
8527 return 1;
8528 }
8529
8530 /* Given the array type ARRAY_TYPE, return nonzero if DESC_TYPE,
8531 a type following the GNAT encoding for describing array type
8532 indices, only carries redundant information. */
8533
8534 static int
8535 ada_is_redundant_index_type_desc (struct type *array_type,
8536 struct type *desc_type)
8537 {
8538 struct type *this_layer = check_typedef (array_type);
8539 int i;
8540
8541 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (desc_type); i++)
8542 {
8543 if (!ada_is_redundant_range_encoding (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (this_layer),
8544 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, i)))
8545 return 0;
8546 this_layer = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (this_layer));
8547 }
8548
8549 return 1;
8550 }
8551
8552 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
8553 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
8554 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
8555 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
8556 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
8557 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
8558 varsize_limit. */
8559
8560 static struct type *
8561 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
8562 int ignore_too_big)
8563 {
8564 struct type *index_type_desc;
8565 struct type *result;
8566 int constrained_packed_array_p;
8567 static const char *xa_suffix = "___XA";
8568
8569 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8570 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8571 return type0;
8572
8573 constrained_packed_array_p = ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
8574 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
8575 type0 = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
8576
8577 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, xa_suffix);
8578
8579 /* As mentioned in exp_dbug.ads, for non bit-packed arrays an
8580 encoding suffixed with 'P' may still be generated. If so,
8581 it should be used to find the XA type. */
8582
8583 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
8584 {
8585 const char *typename = ada_type_name (type0);
8586
8587 if (typename != NULL)
8588 {
8589 const int len = strlen (typename);
8590 char *name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (xa_suffix));
8591
8592 if (typename[len - 1] == 'P')
8593 {
8594 strcpy (name, typename);
8595 strcpy (name + len - 1, xa_suffix);
8596 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type0, name);
8597 }
8598 }
8599 }
8600
8601 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
8602 if (index_type_desc != NULL
8603 && ada_is_redundant_index_type_desc (type0, index_type_desc))
8604 {
8605 /* Ignore this ___XA parallel type, as it does not bring any
8606 useful information. This allows us to avoid creating fixed
8607 versions of the array's index types, which would be identical
8608 to the original ones. This, in turn, can also help avoid
8609 the creation of fixed versions of the array itself. */
8610 index_type_desc = NULL;
8611 }
8612
8613 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
8614 {
8615 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
8616
8617 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
8618 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
8619 debugging data. */
8620 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
8621 We're not providing the address of an element here,
8622 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
8623 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
8624 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
8625 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
8626 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
8627 consult the object tag. */
8628 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
8629
8630 /* Make sure we always create a new array type when dealing with
8631 packed array types, since we're going to fix-up the array
8632 type length and element bitsize a little further down. */
8633 if (elt_type0 == elt_type && !constrained_packed_array_p)
8634 result = type0;
8635 else
8636 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (type0),
8637 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
8638 }
8639 else
8640 {
8641 int i;
8642 struct type *elt_type0;
8643
8644 elt_type0 = type0;
8645 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1)
8646 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
8647
8648 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
8649 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
8650 debugging data. */
8651 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
8652 We're not providing the address of an element here,
8653 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
8654 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
8655 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
8656 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
8657 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
8658 consult the object tag. */
8659 result =
8660 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
8661
8662 elt_type0 = type0;
8663 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
8664 {
8665 struct type *range_type =
8666 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, i), dval);
8667
8668 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (elt_type0),
8669 result, range_type);
8670 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
8671 }
8672 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
8673 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
8674 }
8675
8676 /* We want to preserve the type name. This can be useful when
8677 trying to get the type name of a value that has already been
8678 printed (for instance, if the user did "print VAR; whatis $". */
8679 TYPE_NAME (result) = TYPE_NAME (type0);
8680
8681 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
8682 {
8683 /* So far, the resulting type has been created as if the original
8684 type was a regular (non-packed) array type. As a result, the
8685 bitsize of the array elements needs to be set again, and the array
8686 length needs to be recomputed based on that bitsize. */
8687 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (result) / TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (result));
8688 int elt_bitsize = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
8689
8690 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (result, 0) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
8691 TYPE_LENGTH (result) = len * elt_bitsize / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
8692 if (TYPE_LENGTH (result) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < len * elt_bitsize)
8693 TYPE_LENGTH (result)++;
8694 }
8695
8696 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1;
8697 return result;
8698 }
8699
8700
8701 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
8702 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
8703 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
8704 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
8705 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
8706
8707 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
8708 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
8709 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
8710 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
8711 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
8712
8713 static struct type *
8714 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8715 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8716 {
8717 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8718 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
8719 {
8720 default:
8721 return type;
8722 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8723 {
8724 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
8725 struct type *fixed_record_type =
8726 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
8727
8728 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
8729 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
8730 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
8731 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
8732 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
8733 them). */
8734
8735 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
8736 {
8737 struct value *tag =
8738 value_tag_from_contents_and_address
8739 (fixed_record_type,
8740 valaddr,
8741 address);
8742 struct type *real_type = type_from_tag (tag);
8743 struct value *obj =
8744 value_from_contents_and_address (fixed_record_type,
8745 valaddr,
8746 address);
8747 fixed_record_type = value_type (obj);
8748 if (real_type != NULL)
8749 return to_fixed_record_type
8750 (real_type, NULL,
8751 value_address (ada_tag_value_at_base_address (obj)), NULL);
8752 }
8753
8754 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable.
8755 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */
8756 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL)
8757 {
8758 const char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type);
8759 char *xvz_name = alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */);
8760 int xvz_found = 0;
8761 LONGEST size;
8762
8763 xsnprintf (xvz_name, strlen (name) + 7, "%s___XVZ", name);
8764 size = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, &xvz_found);
8765 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size)
8766 {
8767 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type);
8768 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size;
8769
8770 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have
8771 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and
8772 apparently it is something that is hard to fix.
8773
8774 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition
8775 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us
8776 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we
8777 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type
8778 definition.
8779
8780 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are
8781 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble
8782 when using this type to create new types targeting it.
8783 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check
8784 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace
8785 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn,
8786 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too.
8787 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size
8788 of the array is computed from the number of elements in
8789 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */
8790 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0;
8791 }
8792 }
8793 return fixed_record_type;
8794 }
8795 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8796 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
8797 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8798 if (dval == NULL)
8799 return type;
8800 else
8801 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
8802 }
8803 }
8804
8805 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
8806 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
8807
8808 The typedef layer needs be preserved in order to differentiate between
8809 arrays and array pointers when both types are implemented using the same
8810 fat pointer. In the array pointer case, the pointer is encoded as
8811 a typedef of the pointer type. For instance, considering:
8812
8813 type String_Access is access String;
8814 S1 : String_Access := null;
8815
8816 To the debugger, S1 is defined as a typedef of type String. But
8817 to the user, it is a pointer. So if the user tries to print S1,
8818 we should not dereference the array, but print the array address
8819 instead.
8820
8821 If we didn't preserve the typedef layer, we would lose the fact that
8822 the type is to be presented as a pointer (needs de-reference before
8823 being printed). And we would also use the source-level type name. */
8824
8825 struct type *
8826 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8827 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8828
8829 {
8830 struct type *fixed_type =
8831 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
8832
8833 /* If TYPE is a typedef and its target type is the same as the FIXED_TYPE,
8834 then preserve the typedef layer.
8835
8836 Implementation note: We can only check the main-type portion of
8837 the TYPE and FIXED_TYPE, because eliminating the typedef layer
8838 from TYPE now returns a type that has the same instance flags
8839 as TYPE. For instance, if TYPE is a "typedef const", and its
8840 target type is a "struct", then the typedef elimination will return
8841 a "const" version of the target type. See check_typedef for more
8842 details about how the typedef layer elimination is done.
8843
8844 brobecker/2010-11-19: It seems to me that the only case where it is
8845 useful to preserve the typedef layer is when dealing with fat pointers.
8846 Perhaps, we could add a check for that and preserve the typedef layer
8847 only in that situation. But this seems unecessary so far, probably
8848 because we call check_typedef/ada_check_typedef pretty much everywhere.
8849 */
8850 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
8851 && (TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (ada_typedef_target_type (type))
8852 == TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (fixed_type)))
8853 return type;
8854
8855 return fixed_type;
8856 }
8857
8858 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
8859 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
8860
8861 static struct type *
8862 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8863 {
8864 struct type *type;
8865
8866 if (type0 == NULL)
8867 return NULL;
8868
8869 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8870 return type0;
8871
8872 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8873
8874 switch (TYPE_CODE (type0))
8875 {
8876 default:
8877 return type0;
8878 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8879 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8880 if (type != NULL)
8881 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8882 else
8883 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8884 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8885 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
8886 if (type != NULL)
8887 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8888 else
8889 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8890 }
8891 }
8892
8893 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
8894
8895 static struct type *
8896 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
8897 {
8898 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8899 {
8900 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
8901 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
8902 TYPE_NAME (type1) = ada_type_name (type);
8903
8904 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
8905 }
8906 else
8907 {
8908 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
8909
8910 if (raw_real_type == type)
8911 return type;
8912 else
8913 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
8914 }
8915 }
8916
8917 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
8918 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
8919 type Foo;
8920 type FooP is access Foo;
8921 V: FooP;
8922 type Foo is array ...;
8923 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
8924 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
8925 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
8926 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
8927
8928 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
8929 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
8930
8931 struct type *
8932 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
8933 {
8934 if (type == NULL)
8935 return NULL;
8936
8937 /* If our type is a typedef type of a fat pointer, then we're done.
8938 We don't want to strip the TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF layer, because this is
8939 what allows us to distinguish between fat pointers that represent
8940 array types, and fat pointers that represent array access types
8941 (in both cases, the compiler implements them as fat pointers). */
8942 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
8943 && is_thick_pntr (ada_typedef_target_type (type)))
8944 return type;
8945
8946 CHECK_TYPEDEF (type);
8947 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
8948 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
8949 || TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) == NULL)
8950 return type;
8951 else
8952 {
8953 const char *name = TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
8954 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
8955
8956 if (type1 == NULL)
8957 return type;
8958
8959 /* TYPE1 might itself be a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF (this can happen with
8960 stubs pointing to arrays, as we don't create symbols for array
8961 types, only for the typedef-to-array types). If that's the case,
8962 strip the typedef layer. */
8963 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
8964 type1 = ada_check_typedef (type1);
8965
8966 return type1;
8967 }
8968 }
8969
8970 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
8971 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
8972 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
8973 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
8974 creation of struct values]. */
8975
8976 static struct value *
8977 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
8978 struct value *val0)
8979 {
8980 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
8981
8982 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
8983 return val0;
8984 else
8985 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
8986 }
8987
8988 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
8989 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
8990 value. */
8991
8992 struct value *
8993 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
8994 {
8995 val = unwrap_value (val);
8996 val = ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val),
8997 value_address (val),
8998 val);
8999 return val;
9000 }
9001 \f
9002
9003 /* Attributes */
9004
9005 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
9006 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
9007
9008 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
9009 "<?>",
9010
9011 "first",
9012 "last",
9013 "length",
9014 "image",
9015 "max",
9016 "min",
9017 "modulus",
9018 "pos",
9019 "size",
9020 "tag",
9021 "val",
9022 0
9023 };
9024
9025 const char *
9026 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
9027 {
9028 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
9029 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
9030 else
9031 return attribute_names[0];
9032 }
9033
9034 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
9035
9036 static LONGEST
9037 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
9038 {
9039 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg);
9040 struct type *type = value_type (val);
9041 LONGEST result;
9042
9043 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
9044 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
9045
9046 if (!discrete_position (type, value_as_long (val), &result))
9047 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
9048
9049 return result;
9050 }
9051
9052 static struct value *
9053 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9054 {
9055 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg));
9056 }
9057
9058 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
9059
9060 static struct value *
9061 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9062 {
9063 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
9064 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
9065 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
9066 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
9067
9068 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
9069 {
9070 long pos = value_as_long (arg);
9071
9072 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
9073 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
9074 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, pos));
9075 }
9076 else
9077 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg));
9078 }
9079 \f
9080
9081 /* Evaluation */
9082
9083 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
9084 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
9085 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
9086
9087 int
9088 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
9089 {
9090 const char *name;
9091
9092 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
9093 and don't check any further. */
9094 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
9095 return 1;
9096
9097 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
9098 with a known character type name. */
9099 name = ada_type_name (type);
9100 return (name != NULL
9101 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
9102 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9103 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
9104 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
9105 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
9106 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
9107 }
9108
9109 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
9110
9111 int
9112 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
9113 {
9114 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9115 if (type != NULL
9116 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
9117 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
9118 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9119 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
9120 {
9121 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
9122
9123 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
9124 }
9125 else
9126 return 0;
9127 }
9128
9129 /* The compiler sometimes provides a parallel XVS type for a given
9130 PAD type. Normally, it is safe to follow the PAD type directly,
9131 but older versions of the compiler have a bug that causes the offset
9132 of its "F" field to be wrong. Following that field in that case
9133 would lead to incorrect results, but this can be worked around
9134 by ignoring the PAD type and using the associated XVS type instead.
9135
9136 Set to True if the debugger should trust the contents of PAD types.
9137 Otherwise, ignore the PAD type if there is a parallel XVS type. */
9138 static int trust_pad_over_xvs = 1;
9139
9140 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
9141 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
9142 distinctive name. */
9143
9144 int
9145 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
9146 {
9147 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9148
9149 if (!trust_pad_over_xvs && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
9150 return 0;
9151
9152 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
9153 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1
9154 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
9155 }
9156
9157 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
9158 the parallel type. */
9159
9160 struct type *
9161 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
9162 {
9163 struct type *real_type_namer;
9164 struct type *raw_real_type;
9165
9166 if (raw_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (raw_type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
9167 return raw_type;
9168
9169 if (ada_is_aligner_type (raw_type))
9170 /* The encoding specifies that we should always use the aligner type.
9171 So, even if this aligner type has an associated XVS type, we should
9172 simply ignore it.
9173
9174 According to the compiler gurus, an XVS type parallel to an aligner
9175 type may exist because of a stabs limitation. In stabs, aligner
9176 types are empty because the field has a variable-sized type, and
9177 thus cannot actually be used as an aligner type. As a result,
9178 we need the associated parallel XVS type to decode the type.
9179 Since the policy in the compiler is to not change the internal
9180 representation based on the debugging info format, we sometimes
9181 end up having a redundant XVS type parallel to the aligner type. */
9182 return raw_type;
9183
9184 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
9185 if (real_type_namer == NULL
9186 || TYPE_CODE (real_type_namer) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
9187 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1)
9188 return raw_type;
9189
9190 if (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0)) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
9191 {
9192 /* This is an older encoding form where the base type needs to be
9193 looked up by name. We prefer the newer enconding because it is
9194 more efficient. */
9195 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
9196 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
9197 return raw_type;
9198 else
9199 return raw_real_type;
9200 }
9201
9202 /* The field in our XVS type is a reference to the base type. */
9203 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0));
9204 }
9205
9206 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
9207
9208 struct type *
9209 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
9210 {
9211 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9212 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
9213 else
9214 return ada_get_base_type (type);
9215 }
9216
9217
9218 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
9219 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
9220
9221 const gdb_byte *
9222 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
9223 {
9224 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9225 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
9226 valaddr +
9227 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
9228 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
9229 else
9230 return valaddr;
9231 }
9232
9233
9234
9235 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
9236 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
9237 const char *
9238 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
9239 {
9240 static char *result;
9241 static size_t result_len = 0;
9242 char *tmp;
9243
9244 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
9245 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
9246 all the preceding characters, the unqualified name starts
9247 right after that dot.
9248 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
9249 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
9250 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
9251 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
9252
9253 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
9254 if (tmp != NULL)
9255 name = tmp + 1;
9256 else
9257 {
9258 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
9259 {
9260 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
9261 break;
9262 else
9263 name = tmp + 2;
9264 }
9265 }
9266
9267 if (name[0] == 'Q')
9268 {
9269 int v;
9270
9271 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
9272 {
9273 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
9274 return name;
9275 }
9276 else
9277 return name;
9278
9279 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
9280 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
9281 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", v);
9282 else if (name[1] == 'U')
9283 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
9284 else
9285 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
9286
9287 return result;
9288 }
9289 else
9290 {
9291 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
9292 if (tmp == NULL)
9293 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
9294 if (tmp != NULL)
9295 {
9296 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
9297 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
9298 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
9299 return result;
9300 }
9301
9302 return name;
9303 }
9304 }
9305
9306 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
9307 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
9308 expression. */
9309
9310 static struct value *
9311 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
9312 {
9313 return evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
9314 }
9315
9316 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
9317 value it wraps. */
9318
9319 static struct value *
9320 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
9321 {
9322 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
9323
9324 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9325 {
9326 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
9327 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
9328
9329 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
9330 TYPE_NAME (val_type) = ada_type_name (type);
9331
9332 return unwrap_value (v);
9333 }
9334 else
9335 {
9336 struct type *raw_real_type =
9337 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
9338
9339 /* If there is no parallel XVS or XVE type, then the value is
9340 already unwrapped. Return it without further modification. */
9341 if ((type == raw_real_type)
9342 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE") == NULL)
9343 return val;
9344
9345 return
9346 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
9347 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
9348 value_address (val),
9349 NULL, 1));
9350 }
9351 }
9352
9353 static struct value *
9354 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9355 {
9356 LONGEST val;
9357
9358 if (type == value_type (arg))
9359 return arg;
9360 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
9361 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type,
9362 ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
9363 value_as_long (arg)));
9364 else
9365 {
9366 DOUBLEST argd = value_as_double (arg);
9367
9368 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type, argd);
9369 }
9370
9371 return value_from_longest (type, val);
9372 }
9373
9374 static struct value *
9375 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9376 {
9377 DOUBLEST val = ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
9378 value_as_long (arg));
9379
9380 return value_from_double (type, val);
9381 }
9382
9383 /* Given two array types T1 and T2, return nonzero iff both arrays
9384 contain the same number of elements. */
9385
9386 static int
9387 ada_same_array_size_p (struct type *t1, struct type *t2)
9388 {
9389 LONGEST lo1, hi1, lo2, hi2;
9390
9391 /* Get the array bounds in order to verify that the size of
9392 the two arrays match. */
9393 if (!get_array_bounds (t1, &lo1, &hi1)
9394 || !get_array_bounds (t2, &lo2, &hi2))
9395 error (_("unable to determine array bounds"));
9396
9397 /* To make things easier for size comparison, normalize a bit
9398 the case of empty arrays by making sure that the difference
9399 between upper bound and lower bound is always -1. */
9400 if (lo1 > hi1)
9401 hi1 = lo1 - 1;
9402 if (lo2 > hi2)
9403 hi2 = lo2 - 1;
9404
9405 return (hi1 - lo1 == hi2 - lo2);
9406 }
9407
9408 /* Assuming that VAL is an array of integrals, and TYPE represents
9409 an array with the same number of elements, but with wider integral
9410 elements, return an array "casted" to TYPE. In practice, this
9411 means that the returned array is built by casting each element
9412 of the original array into TYPE's (wider) element type. */
9413
9414 static struct value *
9415 ada_promote_array_of_integrals (struct type *type, struct value *val)
9416 {
9417 struct type *elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9418 LONGEST lo, hi;
9419 struct value *res;
9420 LONGEST i;
9421
9422 /* Verify that both val and type are arrays of scalars, and
9423 that the size of val's elements is smaller than the size
9424 of type's element. */
9425 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
9426 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
9427 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
9428 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val))));
9429 gdb_assert (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))
9430 > TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val))));
9431
9432 if (!get_array_bounds (type, &lo, &hi))
9433 error (_("unable to determine array bounds"));
9434
9435 res = allocate_value (type);
9436
9437 /* Promote each array element. */
9438 for (i = 0; i < hi - lo + 1; i++)
9439 {
9440 struct value *elt = value_cast (elt_type, value_subscript (val, lo + i));
9441
9442 memcpy (value_contents_writeable (res) + (i * TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type)),
9443 value_contents_all (elt), TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type));
9444 }
9445
9446 return res;
9447 }
9448
9449 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
9450 return the converted value. */
9451
9452 static struct value *
9453 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
9454 {
9455 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
9456
9457 if (type == type2)
9458 return val;
9459
9460 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
9461 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9462
9463 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9464 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9465 {
9466 val = ada_value_ind (val);
9467 type2 = value_type (val);
9468 }
9469
9470 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9471 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9472 {
9473 if (!ada_same_array_size_p (type, type2))
9474 error (_("cannot assign arrays of different length"));
9475
9476 if (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))
9477 && is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9478 && TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9479 < TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
9480 {
9481 /* Allow implicit promotion of the array elements to
9482 a wider type. */
9483 return ada_promote_array_of_integrals (type, val);
9484 }
9485
9486 if (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9487 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
9488 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
9489 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
9490 }
9491 return val;
9492 }
9493
9494 static struct value *
9495 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
9496 {
9497 struct value *val;
9498 struct type *type1, *type2;
9499 LONGEST v, v1, v2;
9500
9501 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
9502 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
9503 type1 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
9504 type2 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
9505
9506 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) != TYPE_CODE_INT
9507 || TYPE_CODE (type2) != TYPE_CODE_INT)
9508 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9509
9510 switch (op)
9511 {
9512 case BINOP_MOD:
9513 case BINOP_DIV:
9514 case BINOP_REM:
9515 break;
9516 default:
9517 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9518 }
9519
9520 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
9521 if (v2 == 0)
9522 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
9523
9524 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
9525 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9526
9527 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
9528 switch (op)
9529 {
9530 case BINOP_DIV:
9531 v = v1 / v2;
9532 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
9533 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
9534 break;
9535 case BINOP_REM:
9536 v = v1 % v2;
9537 if (v * v1 < 0)
9538 v -= v2;
9539 break;
9540 default:
9541 /* Should not reach this point. */
9542 v = 0;
9543 }
9544
9545 val = allocate_value (type1);
9546 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
9547 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)),
9548 gdbarch_byte_order (get_type_arch (type1)), v);
9549 return val;
9550 }
9551
9552 static int
9553 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
9554 {
9555 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
9556 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
9557 {
9558 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
9559 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
9560 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
9561 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
9562
9563 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9564 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
9565 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9566 || TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9567 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
9568 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
9569 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
9570 and do not have user-defined equality. */
9571 return
9572 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg2))
9573 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
9574 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1))) == 0;
9575 }
9576 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
9577 }
9578
9579 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
9580 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
9581 OP_AGGREGATE. */
9582
9583 static int
9584 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
9585 {
9586 int n, m, i;
9587
9588 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
9589 pc += 3;
9590 n = 0;
9591 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
9592 {
9593 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
9594 {
9595 default:
9596 n += 1;
9597 break;
9598 case OP_CHOICES:
9599 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
9600 break;
9601 }
9602 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
9603 }
9604 return n;
9605 }
9606
9607 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
9608 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
9609 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
9610 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
9611 LHS == CONTAINER). */
9612
9613 static void
9614 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
9615 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
9616 {
9617 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
9618 struct value *elt;
9619
9620 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (lhs)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9621 {
9622 struct type *index_type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9623 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (index_type, index);
9624
9625 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
9626 }
9627 else
9628 {
9629 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
9630 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (elt);
9631 }
9632
9633 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
9634 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
9635 else
9636 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
9637 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9638 EVAL_NORMAL));
9639
9640 value_free_to_mark (mark);
9641 }
9642
9643 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
9644 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
9645 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
9646 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
9647 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
9648 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
9649 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
9650
9651 static struct value *
9652 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
9653 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9654 int *pos, enum noside noside)
9655 {
9656 struct type *lhs_type;
9657 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
9658 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
9659 int num_specs;
9660 LONGEST *indices;
9661 int max_indices, num_indices;
9662 int i;
9663
9664 *pos += 3;
9665 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
9666 {
9667 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
9668 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
9669 return container;
9670 }
9671
9672 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
9673 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
9674 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
9675 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
9676 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
9677 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
9678
9679 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
9680 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
9681 {
9682 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
9683 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
9684 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
9685 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
9686 }
9687 else if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
9688 {
9689 low_index = 0;
9690 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
9691 }
9692 else
9693 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
9694
9695 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
9696 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
9697 indices = alloca (max_indices * sizeof (indices[0]));
9698 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
9699 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
9700 num_indices = 4;
9701
9702 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
9703 {
9704 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
9705 {
9706 case OP_CHOICES:
9707 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9708 &num_indices, max_indices,
9709 low_index, high_index);
9710 break;
9711 case OP_POSITIONAL:
9712 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9713 &num_indices, max_indices,
9714 low_index, high_index);
9715 break;
9716 case OP_OTHERS:
9717 if (i != n-1)
9718 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
9719 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9720 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
9721 break;
9722 default:
9723 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
9724 }
9725 }
9726
9727 return container;
9728 }
9729
9730 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
9731 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
9732 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
9733 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
9734 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
9735 assign_aggregate. */
9736 static void
9737 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
9738 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9739 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
9740 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9741 {
9742 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
9743
9744 if (ind - 1 == high)
9745 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
9746 if (ind <= high)
9747 {
9748 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
9749 *pos += 3;
9750 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
9751 }
9752 else
9753 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9754 }
9755
9756 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
9757 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
9758 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
9759 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
9760 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9761 static void
9762 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
9763 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9764 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
9765 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9766 {
9767 int j;
9768 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
9769 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
9770 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
9771
9772 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
9773
9774 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
9775 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9776 expr_pc = *pos;
9777 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9778
9779 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
9780 {
9781 LONGEST lower, upper;
9782 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
9783
9784 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
9785 {
9786 choice_pos += 1;
9787 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9788 EVAL_NORMAL));
9789 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9790 EVAL_NORMAL));
9791 }
9792 else if (is_array)
9793 {
9794 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
9795 EVAL_NORMAL));
9796 upper = lower;
9797 }
9798 else
9799 {
9800 int ind;
9801 const char *name;
9802
9803 switch (op)
9804 {
9805 case OP_NAME:
9806 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
9807 break;
9808 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9809 name = SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol);
9810 break;
9811 default:
9812 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
9813 }
9814 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9815 ind = 0;
9816 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
9817 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
9818 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
9819 lower = upper = ind;
9820 }
9821
9822 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
9823 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
9824
9825 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
9826 max_indices);
9827 while (lower <= upper)
9828 {
9829 int pos1;
9830
9831 pos1 = expr_pc;
9832 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
9833 lower += 1;
9834 }
9835 }
9836 }
9837
9838 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
9839 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
9840 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
9841 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
9842 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9843 static void
9844 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
9845 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9846 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
9847 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9848 {
9849 int i;
9850 int expr_pc = *pos + 1;
9851
9852 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
9853 {
9854 LONGEST ind;
9855
9856 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
9857 {
9858 int localpos;
9859
9860 localpos = expr_pc;
9861 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &localpos);
9862 }
9863 }
9864 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9865 }
9866
9867 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
9868 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
9869 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
9870 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
9871 static void
9872 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
9873 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
9874 {
9875 int i, j;
9876
9877 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
9878 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
9879 {
9880 int kh;
9881
9882 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
9883 if (high < indices[kh])
9884 break;
9885 if (low < indices[i])
9886 indices[i] = low;
9887 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
9888 if (high > indices[i + 1])
9889 indices[i + 1] = high;
9890 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
9891 *size -= kh - i - 2;
9892 return;
9893 }
9894 else if (high < indices[i])
9895 break;
9896 }
9897
9898 if (*size == max_size)
9899 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
9900 *size += 2;
9901 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
9902 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
9903 indices[i] = low;
9904 indices[i + 1] = high;
9905 }
9906
9907 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
9908 is different. */
9909
9910 static struct value *
9911 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2, enum noside noside)
9912 {
9913 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
9914 return arg2;
9915
9916 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (type))
9917 return (cast_to_fixed (type, arg2));
9918
9919 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9920 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
9921
9922 return value_cast (type, arg2);
9923 }
9924
9925 /* Evaluating Ada expressions, and printing their result.
9926 ------------------------------------------------------
9927
9928 1. Introduction:
9929 ----------------
9930
9931 We usually evaluate an Ada expression in order to print its value.
9932 We also evaluate an expression in order to print its type, which
9933 happens during the EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase of the evaluation,
9934 but we'll focus mostly on the EVAL_NORMAL phase. In practice, the
9935 EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase allows us to simplify certain aspects of
9936 the evaluation compared to the EVAL_NORMAL, but is otherwise very
9937 similar.
9938
9939 Evaluating expressions is a little more complicated for Ada entities
9940 than it is for entities in languages such as C. The main reason for
9941 this is that Ada provides types whose definition might be dynamic.
9942 One example of such types is variant records. Or another example
9943 would be an array whose bounds can only be known at run time.
9944
9945 The following description is a general guide as to what should be
9946 done (and what should NOT be done) in order to evaluate an expression
9947 involving such types, and when. This does not cover how the semantic
9948 information is encoded by GNAT as this is covered separatly. For the
9949 document used as the reference for the GNAT encoding, see exp_dbug.ads
9950 in the GNAT sources.
9951
9952 Ideally, we should embed each part of this description next to its
9953 associated code. Unfortunately, the amount of code is so vast right
9954 now that it's hard to see whether the code handling a particular
9955 situation might be duplicated or not. One day, when the code is
9956 cleaned up, this guide might become redundant with the comments
9957 inserted in the code, and we might want to remove it.
9958
9959 2. ``Fixing'' an Entity, the Simple Case:
9960 -----------------------------------------
9961
9962 When evaluating Ada expressions, the tricky issue is that they may
9963 reference entities whose type contents and size are not statically
9964 known. Consider for instance a variant record:
9965
9966 type Rec (Empty : Boolean := True) is record
9967 case Empty is
9968 when True => null;
9969 when False => Value : Integer;
9970 end case;
9971 end record;
9972 Yes : Rec := (Empty => False, Value => 1);
9973 No : Rec := (empty => True);
9974
9975 The size and contents of that record depends on the value of the
9976 descriminant (Rec.Empty). At this point, neither the debugging
9977 information nor the associated type structure in GDB are able to
9978 express such dynamic types. So what the debugger does is to create
9979 "fixed" versions of the type that applies to the specific object.
9980 We also informally refer to this opperation as "fixing" an object,
9981 which means creating its associated fixed type.
9982
9983 Example: when printing the value of variable "Yes" above, its fixed
9984 type would look like this:
9985
9986 type Rec is record
9987 Empty : Boolean;
9988 Value : Integer;
9989 end record;
9990
9991 On the other hand, if we printed the value of "No", its fixed type
9992 would become:
9993
9994 type Rec is record
9995 Empty : Boolean;
9996 end record;
9997
9998 Things become a little more complicated when trying to fix an entity
9999 with a dynamic type that directly contains another dynamic type,
10000 such as an array of variant records, for instance. There are
10001 two possible cases: Arrays, and records.
10002
10003 3. ``Fixing'' Arrays:
10004 ---------------------
10005
10006 The type structure in GDB describes an array in terms of its bounds,
10007 and the type of its elements. By design, all elements in the array
10008 have the same type and we cannot represent an array of variant elements
10009 using the current type structure in GDB. When fixing an array,
10010 we cannot fix the array element, as we would potentially need one
10011 fixed type per element of the array. As a result, the best we can do
10012 when fixing an array is to produce an array whose bounds and size
10013 are correct (allowing us to read it from memory), but without having
10014 touched its element type. Fixing each element will be done later,
10015 when (if) necessary.
10016
10017 Arrays are a little simpler to handle than records, because the same
10018 amount of memory is allocated for each element of the array, even if
10019 the amount of space actually used by each element differs from element
10020 to element. Consider for instance the following array of type Rec:
10021
10022 type Rec_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Rec;
10023
10024 The actual amount of memory occupied by each element might be different
10025 from element to element, depending on the value of their discriminant.
10026 But the amount of space reserved for each element in the array remains
10027 fixed regardless. So we simply need to compute that size using
10028 the debugging information available, from which we can then determine
10029 the array size (we multiply the number of elements of the array by
10030 the size of each element).
10031
10032 The simplest case is when we have an array of a constrained element
10033 type. For instance, consider the following type declarations:
10034
10035 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Integer) is
10036 Length : Integer;
10037 Buffer : String (1 .. Max_Size);
10038 end record;
10039 type Bounded_String_Array is array (1 ..2) of Bounded_String (80);
10040
10041 In this case, the compiler describes the array as an array of
10042 variable-size elements (identified by its XVS suffix) for which
10043 the size can be read in the parallel XVZ variable.
10044
10045 In the case of an array of an unconstrained element type, the compiler
10046 wraps the array element inside a private PAD type. This type should not
10047 be shown to the user, and must be "unwrap"'ed before printing. Note
10048 that we also use the adjective "aligner" in our code to designate
10049 these wrapper types.
10050
10051 In some cases, the size allocated for each element is statically
10052 known. In that case, the PAD type already has the correct size,
10053 and the array element should remain unfixed.
10054
10055 But there are cases when this size is not statically known.
10056 For instance, assuming that "Five" is an integer variable:
10057
10058 type Dynamic is array (1 .. Five) of Integer;
10059 type Wrapper (Has_Length : Boolean := False) is record
10060 Data : Dynamic;
10061 case Has_Length is
10062 when True => Length : Integer;
10063 when False => null;
10064 end case;
10065 end record;
10066 type Wrapper_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Wrapper;
10067
10068 Hello : Wrapper_Array := (others => (Has_Length => True,
10069 Data => (others => 17),
10070 Length => 1));
10071
10072
10073 The debugging info would describe variable Hello as being an
10074 array of a PAD type. The size of that PAD type is not statically
10075 known, but can be determined using a parallel XVZ variable.
10076 In that case, a copy of the PAD type with the correct size should
10077 be used for the fixed array.
10078
10079 3. ``Fixing'' record type objects:
10080 ----------------------------------
10081
10082 Things are slightly different from arrays in the case of dynamic
10083 record types. In this case, in order to compute the associated
10084 fixed type, we need to determine the size and offset of each of
10085 its components. This, in turn, requires us to compute the fixed
10086 type of each of these components.
10087
10088 Consider for instance the example:
10089
10090 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Natural) is record
10091 Str : String (1 .. Max_Size);
10092 Length : Natural;
10093 end record;
10094 My_String : Bounded_String (Max_Size => 10);
10095
10096 In that case, the position of field "Length" depends on the size
10097 of field Str, which itself depends on the value of the Max_Size
10098 discriminant. In order to fix the type of variable My_String,
10099 we need to fix the type of field Str. Therefore, fixing a variant
10100 record requires us to fix each of its components.
10101
10102 However, if a component does not have a dynamic size, the component
10103 should not be fixed. In particular, fields that use a PAD type
10104 should not fixed. Here is an example where this might happen
10105 (assuming type Rec above):
10106
10107 type Container (Big : Boolean) is record
10108 First : Rec;
10109 After : Integer;
10110 case Big is
10111 when True => Another : Integer;
10112 when False => null;
10113 end case;
10114 end record;
10115 My_Container : Container := (Big => False,
10116 First => (Empty => True),
10117 After => 42);
10118
10119 In that example, the compiler creates a PAD type for component First,
10120 whose size is constant, and then positions the component After just
10121 right after it. The offset of component After is therefore constant
10122 in this case.
10123
10124 The debugger computes the position of each field based on an algorithm
10125 that uses, among other things, the actual position and size of the field
10126 preceding it. Let's now imagine that the user is trying to print
10127 the value of My_Container. If the type fixing was recursive, we would
10128 end up computing the offset of field After based on the size of the
10129 fixed version of field First. And since in our example First has
10130 only one actual field, the size of the fixed type is actually smaller
10131 than the amount of space allocated to that field, and thus we would
10132 compute the wrong offset of field After.
10133
10134 To make things more complicated, we need to watch out for dynamic
10135 components of variant records (identified by the ___XVL suffix in
10136 the component name). Even if the target type is a PAD type, the size
10137 of that type might not be statically known. So the PAD type needs
10138 to be unwrapped and the resulting type needs to be fixed. Otherwise,
10139 we might end up with the wrong size for our component. This can be
10140 observed with the following type declarations:
10141
10142 type Octal is new Integer range 0 .. 7;
10143 type Octal_Array is array (Positive range <>) of Octal;
10144 pragma Pack (Octal_Array);
10145
10146 type Octal_Buffer (Size : Positive) is record
10147 Buffer : Octal_Array (1 .. Size);
10148 Length : Integer;
10149 end record;
10150
10151 In that case, Buffer is a PAD type whose size is unset and needs
10152 to be computed by fixing the unwrapped type.
10153
10154 4. When to ``Fix'' un-``Fixed'' sub-elements of an entity:
10155 ----------------------------------------------------------
10156
10157 Lastly, when should the sub-elements of an entity that remained unfixed
10158 thus far, be actually fixed?
10159
10160 The answer is: Only when referencing that element. For instance
10161 when selecting one component of a record, this specific component
10162 should be fixed at that point in time. Or when printing the value
10163 of a record, each component should be fixed before its value gets
10164 printed. Similarly for arrays, the element of the array should be
10165 fixed when printing each element of the array, or when extracting
10166 one element out of that array. On the other hand, fixing should
10167 not be performed on the elements when taking a slice of an array!
10168
10169 Note that one of the side-effects of miscomputing the offset and
10170 size of each field is that we end up also miscomputing the size
10171 of the containing type. This can have adverse results when computing
10172 the value of an entity. GDB fetches the value of an entity based
10173 on the size of its type, and thus a wrong size causes GDB to fetch
10174 the wrong amount of memory. In the case where the computed size is
10175 too small, GDB fetches too little data to print the value of our
10176 entiry. Results in this case as unpredicatble, as we usually read
10177 past the buffer containing the data =:-o. */
10178
10179 /* Implement the evaluate_exp routine in the exp_descriptor structure
10180 for the Ada language. */
10181
10182 static struct value *
10183 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
10184 int *pos, enum noside noside)
10185 {
10186 enum exp_opcode op;
10187 int tem;
10188 int pc;
10189 int preeval_pos;
10190 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
10191 struct type *type;
10192 int nargs, oplen;
10193 struct value **argvec;
10194
10195 pc = *pos;
10196 *pos += 1;
10197 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
10198
10199 switch (op)
10200 {
10201 default:
10202 *pos -= 1;
10203 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10204
10205 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
10206 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
10207
10208 /* If evaluating an OP_DOUBLE and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
10209 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
10210 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
10211 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
10212 types in Ada have different representations.
10213
10214 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
10215 ourselves. */
10216 if ((op == OP_DOUBLE || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
10217 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1, noside);
10218
10219 return arg1;
10220
10221 case OP_STRING:
10222 {
10223 struct value *result;
10224
10225 *pos -= 1;
10226 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10227 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
10228 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
10229 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
10230 TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) = TYPE_CODE_ARRAY;
10231 return result;
10232 }
10233
10234 case UNOP_CAST:
10235 (*pos) += 2;
10236 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
10237 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
10238 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10239 goto nosideret;
10240 arg1 = ada_value_cast (type, arg1, noside);
10241 return arg1;
10242
10243 case UNOP_QUAL:
10244 (*pos) += 2;
10245 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
10246 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
10247
10248 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
10249 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10250 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
10251 {
10252 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
10253 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10254 return arg1;
10255 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
10256 }
10257 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
10258 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
10259 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
10260 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
10261 type = value_type (arg1);
10262 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
10263 type = NULL;
10264 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
10265 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10266 return arg1;
10267 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10268 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
10269 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10270 error
10271 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
10272 else
10273 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
10274 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
10275
10276 case BINOP_ADD:
10277 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10278 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10279 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10280 goto nosideret;
10281 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10282 return (value_from_longest
10283 (value_type (arg1),
10284 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
10285 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10286 return (value_from_longest
10287 (value_type (arg2),
10288 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
10289 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
10290 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10291 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
10292 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
10293 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
10294 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
10295 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
10296 type = value_type (arg1);
10297 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10298 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10299 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10300 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD));
10301
10302 case BINOP_SUB:
10303 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10304 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10305 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10306 goto nosideret;
10307 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10308 return (value_from_longest
10309 (value_type (arg1),
10310 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
10311 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10312 return (value_from_longest
10313 (value_type (arg2),
10314 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
10315 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
10316 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10317 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
10318 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction "
10319 "must have the same type"));
10320 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
10321 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
10322 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
10323 type = value_type (arg1);
10324 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10325 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10326 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10327 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB));
10328
10329 case BINOP_MUL:
10330 case BINOP_DIV:
10331 case BINOP_REM:
10332 case BINOP_MOD:
10333 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10334 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10335 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10336 goto nosideret;
10337 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10338 {
10339 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10340 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
10341 }
10342 else
10343 {
10344 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double;
10345 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10346 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1);
10347 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10348 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
10349 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10350 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
10351 }
10352
10353 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10354 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10355 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10356 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
10357 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10358 goto nosideret;
10359 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10360 tem = 0;
10361 else
10362 {
10363 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10364 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
10365 }
10366 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
10367 tem = !tem;
10368 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10369 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem);
10370
10371 case UNOP_NEG:
10372 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10373 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10374 goto nosideret;
10375 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10376 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
10377 else
10378 {
10379 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
10380 return value_neg (arg1);
10381 }
10382
10383 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10384 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10385 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10386 {
10387 struct value *val;
10388
10389 *pos -= 1;
10390 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10391 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10392 return value_cast (type, val);
10393 }
10394
10395 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10396 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10397 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10398 {
10399 struct value *val;
10400
10401 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
10402 *pos = pc;
10403 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10404
10405 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
10406 }
10407
10408 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10409 *pos -= 1;
10410
10411 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10412 {
10413 *pos += 4;
10414 goto nosideret;
10415 }
10416
10417 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
10418 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
10419 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
10420 invalid. */
10421 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
10422 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
10423
10424 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10425 {
10426 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
10427 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle
10428 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but
10429 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types.
10430 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas
10431 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */
10432 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0)
10433 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10434 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0)))
10435 {
10436 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real
10437 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the
10438 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's
10439 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object
10440 type from its tag.
10441
10442 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract
10443 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase
10444 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones.
10445 This can cause problems when trying to print the type
10446 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size:
10447 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order
10448 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description.
10449 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into
10450 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name,
10451 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor
10452 type in the type description. */
10453 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
10454
10455 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
10456 {
10457 struct type *actual_type;
10458
10459 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1));
10460 if (actual_type == NULL)
10461 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine
10462 the actual type from the tag, then use the static
10463 approximation that we just computed as a fallback.
10464 This can happen if the debugging information is
10465 incomplete, for instance. */
10466 actual_type = type;
10467 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval);
10468 }
10469 else
10470 {
10471 /* In the case of a ref, ada_coerce_ref takes care
10472 of determining the actual type. But the evaluation
10473 should return a ref as it should be valid to ask
10474 for its address; so rebuild a ref after coerce. */
10475 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
10476 return value_ref (arg1);
10477 }
10478 }
10479
10480 /* Records and unions for which GNAT encodings have been
10481 generated need to be statically fixed as well.
10482 Otherwise, non-static fixing produces a type where
10483 all dynamic properties are removed, which prevents "ptype"
10484 from being able to completely describe the type.
10485 For instance, a case statement in a variant record would be
10486 replaced by the relevant components based on the actual
10487 value of the discriminants. */
10488 if ((TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10489 && dynamic_template_type (type) != NULL)
10490 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
10491 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVU") != NULL))
10492 {
10493 *pos += 4;
10494 return value_zero (to_static_fixed_type (type), not_lval);
10495 }
10496 }
10497
10498 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10499 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
10500
10501 case OP_FUNCALL:
10502 (*pos) += 2;
10503
10504 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
10505 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
10506 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10507 argvec =
10508 (struct value **) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 2));
10509
10510 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
10511 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
10512 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
10513 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
10514 else
10515 {
10516 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
10517 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10518 argvec[tem] = 0;
10519
10520 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10521 goto nosideret;
10522 }
10523
10524 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type
10525 (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
10526 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
10527 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10528 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (value_type (argvec[0]), 0) != 0)
10529 /* This is a packed array that has already been fixed, and
10530 therefore already coerced to a simple array. Nothing further
10531 to do. */
10532 ;
10533 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10534 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10535 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory))
10536 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
10537
10538 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
10539
10540 /* Ada allows us to implicitly dereference arrays when subscripting
10541 them. So, if this is an array typedef (encoding use for array
10542 access types encoded as fat pointers), strip it now. */
10543 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
10544 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
10545
10546 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10547 {
10548 switch (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))))
10549 {
10550 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
10551 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10552 break;
10553 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
10554 break;
10555 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
10556 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10557 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
10558 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10559 break;
10560 default:
10561 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
10562 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
10563 break;
10564 }
10565 }
10566
10567 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
10568 {
10569 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
10570 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10571 {
10572 struct type *rtype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10573
10574 if (TYPE_GNU_IFUNC (type))
10575 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (rtype));
10576 return allocate_value (rtype);
10577 }
10578 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
10579 case TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION:
10580 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10581 /* We don't know anything about what the internal
10582 function might return, but we have to return
10583 something. */
10584 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10585 not_lval);
10586 else
10587 return call_internal_function (exp->gdbarch, exp->language_defn,
10588 argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
10589
10590 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
10591 {
10592 int arity;
10593
10594 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
10595 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10596 if (type == NULL)
10597 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
10598 if (arity != nargs)
10599 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
10600 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10601 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10602 return
10603 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
10604 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
10605 }
10606 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
10607 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10608 {
10609 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10610 if (type == NULL)
10611 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
10612 else
10613 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10614 }
10615 return
10616 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
10617 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
10618 nargs, argvec + 1));
10619 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
10620 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10621 {
10622 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
10623 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10624 if (type == NULL)
10625 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
10626 else
10627 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10628 }
10629 return
10630 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0],
10631 nargs, argvec + 1));
10632
10633 default:
10634 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
10635 "array or function"));
10636 }
10637
10638 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10639 {
10640 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10641 struct value *low_bound_val =
10642 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10643 struct value *high_bound_val =
10644 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10645 LONGEST low_bound;
10646 LONGEST high_bound;
10647
10648 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
10649 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
10650 low_bound = value_as_long (low_bound_val);
10651 high_bound = value_as_long (high_bound_val);
10652
10653 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10654 goto nosideret;
10655
10656 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
10657 the aligners. */
10658 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10659 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
10660 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
10661 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
10662
10663 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
10664 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
10665
10666 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
10667 convert to a pointer. */
10668 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10669 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10670 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
10671 array = value_addr (array);
10672
10673 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
10674 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
10675 (value_type (array))))
10676 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound);
10677
10678 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
10679
10680 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
10681 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
10682 while (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
10683 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)))
10684 == TYPE_CODE_PTR))
10685 array = value_ind (array);
10686
10687 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
10688 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
10689 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
10690 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
10691 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
10692 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
10693
10694 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (array)))
10695 == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10696 {
10697 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
10698
10699 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10700 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), low_bound);
10701 else
10702 {
10703 struct type *arr_type0 =
10704 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), NULL, 1);
10705
10706 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0,
10707 longest_to_int (low_bound),
10708 longest_to_int (high_bound));
10709 }
10710 }
10711 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10712 return array;
10713 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
10714 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound);
10715 else
10716 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
10717 longest_to_int (high_bound));
10718 }
10719
10720 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
10721 (*pos) += 2;
10722 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10723 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
10724
10725 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10726 goto nosideret;
10727
10728 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
10729 {
10730 default:
10731 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
10732 "always returns true"));
10733 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10734 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1);
10735
10736 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
10737 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
10738 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
10739 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10740 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10741 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10742 return
10743 value_from_longest (type,
10744 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10745 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10746 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10747 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10748 }
10749
10750 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
10751 (*pos) += 2;
10752 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10753 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10754
10755 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10756 goto nosideret;
10757
10758 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10759 {
10760 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10761 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10762 }
10763
10764 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10765
10766 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg2), tem, "range");
10767 if (!type)
10768 type = value_type (arg1);
10769
10770 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1));
10771 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0));
10772
10773 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10774 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10775 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10776 return
10777 value_from_longest (type,
10778 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10779 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10780 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10781 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10782
10783 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
10784 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10785 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10786 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10787
10788 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10789 goto nosideret;
10790
10791 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10792 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10793 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10794 return
10795 value_from_longest (type,
10796 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10797 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10798 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10799 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10800
10801 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10802 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10803 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10804 {
10805 struct type *type_arg;
10806
10807 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
10808 {
10809 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10810 arg1 = NULL;
10811 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
10812 }
10813 else
10814 {
10815 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10816 type_arg = NULL;
10817 }
10818
10819 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
10820 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
10821 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
10822 *pos += 4;
10823
10824 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10825 goto nosideret;
10826
10827 if (type_arg == NULL)
10828 {
10829 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
10830
10831 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
10832 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
10833
10834 if (op == OP_ATR_LENGTH)
10835 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10836 else
10837 {
10838 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem,
10839 ada_attribute_name (op));
10840 if (type == NULL)
10841 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10842 }
10843
10844 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10845 return allocate_value (type);
10846
10847 switch (op)
10848 {
10849 default: /* Should never happen. */
10850 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10851 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10852 return value_from_longest
10853 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0));
10854 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10855 return value_from_longest
10856 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1));
10857 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10858 return value_from_longest
10859 (type, ada_array_length (arg1, tem));
10860 }
10861 }
10862 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
10863 {
10864 struct type *range_type;
10865 const char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
10866
10867 range_type = NULL;
10868 if (name != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type_arg) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
10869 range_type = to_fixed_range_type (type_arg, NULL);
10870 if (range_type == NULL)
10871 range_type = type_arg;
10872 switch (op)
10873 {
10874 default:
10875 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10876 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10877 return value_from_longest
10878 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_low_bound (range_type));
10879 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10880 return value_from_longest
10881 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_high_bound (range_type));
10882 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10883 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
10884 }
10885 }
10886 else if (TYPE_CODE (type_arg) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
10887 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
10888 else
10889 {
10890 LONGEST low, high;
10891
10892 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
10893 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
10894
10895 if (op == OP_ATR_LENGTH)
10896 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10897 else
10898 {
10899 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem, ada_attribute_name (op));
10900 if (type == NULL)
10901 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10902 }
10903
10904 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10905 return allocate_value (type);
10906
10907 switch (op)
10908 {
10909 default:
10910 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10911 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10912 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
10913 return value_from_longest (type, low);
10914 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10915 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
10916 return value_from_longest (type, high);
10917 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10918 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
10919 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
10920 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
10921 }
10922 }
10923 }
10924
10925 case OP_ATR_TAG:
10926 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10927 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10928 goto nosideret;
10929
10930 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10931 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
10932
10933 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
10934
10935 case OP_ATR_MIN:
10936 case OP_ATR_MAX:
10937 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10938 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10939 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10940 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10941 goto nosideret;
10942 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10943 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
10944 else
10945 {
10946 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10947 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
10948 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
10949 }
10950
10951 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
10952 {
10953 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
10954
10955 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10956 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10957 goto nosideret;
10958
10959 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
10960 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
10961
10962 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
10963 ada_modulus (type_arg));
10964 }
10965
10966
10967 case OP_ATR_POS:
10968 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10969 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10970 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10971 goto nosideret;
10972 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10973 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10974 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10975 else
10976 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1);
10977
10978 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
10979 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10980 type = value_type (arg1);
10981
10982 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since
10983 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object,
10984 not the size of the pointer. */
10985 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10986 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10987
10988 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10989 goto nosideret;
10990 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10991 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, not_lval);
10992 else
10993 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10994 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type));
10995
10996 case OP_ATR_VAL:
10997 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10998 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10999 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
11000 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11001 goto nosideret;
11002 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11003 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
11004 else
11005 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
11006
11007 case BINOP_EXP:
11008 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11009 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11010 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11011 goto nosideret;
11012 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11013 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
11014 else
11015 {
11016 /* For integer exponentiation operations,
11017 only promote the first argument. */
11018 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2)))
11019 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
11020 else
11021 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
11022
11023 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
11024 }
11025
11026 case UNOP_PLUS:
11027 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11028 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11029 goto nosideret;
11030 else
11031 return arg1;
11032
11033 case UNOP_ABS:
11034 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11035 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11036 goto nosideret;
11037 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
11038 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
11039 return value_neg (arg1);
11040 else
11041 return arg1;
11042
11043 case UNOP_IND:
11044 preeval_pos = *pos;
11045 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11046 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11047 goto nosideret;
11048 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
11049 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11050 {
11051 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
11052 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
11053 {
11054 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
11055
11056 if (arrType == NULL)
11057 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
11058 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
11059 }
11060 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
11061 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
11062 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
11063 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
11064 {
11065 /* As mentioned in the OP_VAR_VALUE case, tagged types can
11066 only be determined by inspecting the object's tag.
11067 This means that we need to evaluate completely the
11068 expression in order to get its type. */
11069
11070 if ((TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
11071 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
11072 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0))
11073 {
11074 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, &preeval_pos,
11075 EVAL_NORMAL);
11076 type = value_type (ada_value_ind (arg1));
11077 }
11078 else
11079 {
11080 type = to_static_fixed_type
11081 (ada_aligned_type
11082 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
11083 }
11084 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (type);
11085 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
11086 }
11087 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
11088 {
11089 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
11090 if (expect_type == NULL)
11091 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11092 lval_memory);
11093 else
11094 {
11095 expect_type =
11096 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type));
11097 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory);
11098 }
11099 }
11100 else
11101 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
11102 }
11103 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
11104 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
11105
11106 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
11107 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given
11108 the expect_type, then use that as the target type.
11109 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */
11110 {
11111 if (expect_type != NULL)
11112 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type),
11113 arg1));
11114 else
11115 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11116 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1));
11117 }
11118
11119 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
11120 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
11121 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
11122 else
11123 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
11124
11125 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
11126 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
11127 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
11128 preeval_pos = *pos;
11129 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11130 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11131 goto nosideret;
11132 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11133 {
11134 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
11135
11136 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
11137 {
11138 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
11139 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
11140 1, 1, NULL);
11141
11142 /* If the field is not found, check if it exists in the
11143 extension of this object's type. This means that we
11144 need to evaluate completely the expression. */
11145
11146 if (type == NULL)
11147 {
11148 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, &preeval_pos,
11149 EVAL_NORMAL);
11150 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1,
11151 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
11152 0);
11153 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
11154 type = value_type (ada_to_fixed_value (arg1));
11155 }
11156 }
11157 else
11158 type =
11159 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
11160 0, NULL);
11161
11162 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
11163 }
11164 else
11165 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0);
11166 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
11167 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
11168
11169 case OP_TYPE:
11170 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
11171 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
11172 (*pos) += 2;
11173 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11174 goto nosideret;
11175 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11176 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
11177 else
11178 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
11179
11180 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11181 case OP_CHOICES:
11182 case OP_OTHERS:
11183 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
11184 case OP_POSITIONAL:
11185 case OP_NAME:
11186 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
11187 switch (op)
11188 {
11189 case OP_NAME:
11190 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
11191 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
11192 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11193 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
11194 default:
11195 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11196 _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
11197 }
11198
11199 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
11200 *pos += oplen - 1;
11201 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
11202 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
11203 goto nosideret;
11204 }
11205
11206 nosideret:
11207 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 1);
11208 }
11209 \f
11210
11211 /* Fixed point */
11212
11213 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
11214 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
11215 Otherwise, return NULL. */
11216
11217 static const char *
11218 fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
11219 {
11220 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
11221 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : TYPE_CODE (type);
11222
11223 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
11224 {
11225 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
11226
11227 if (tail == NULL)
11228 return NULL;
11229 else
11230 return tail + 5;
11231 }
11232 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
11233 return fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
11234 else
11235 return NULL;
11236 }
11237
11238 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
11239
11240 int
11241 ada_is_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
11242 {
11243 return fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
11244 }
11245
11246 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
11247
11248 int
11249 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
11250 {
11251 return (TYPE_NAME (type)
11252 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (type), "system__address") == 0);
11253 }
11254
11255 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
11256 type, return its delta, or -1 if the type is malformed and the
11257 delta cannot be determined. */
11258
11259 DOUBLEST
11260 ada_delta (struct type *type)
11261 {
11262 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
11263 DOUBLEST num, den;
11264
11265 /* Strictly speaking, num and den are encoded as integer. However,
11266 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
11267 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
11268 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
11269 &num, &den) < 2)
11270 return -1.0;
11271 else
11272 return num / den;
11273 }
11274
11275 /* Assuming that ada_is_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return the scaling
11276 factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
11277
11278 static DOUBLEST
11279 scaling_factor (struct type *type)
11280 {
11281 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
11282 DOUBLEST num0, den0, num1, den1;
11283 int n;
11284
11285 /* Strictly speaking, num's and den's are encoded as integer. However,
11286 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
11287 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
11288 n = sscanf (encoding,
11289 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT
11290 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
11291 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
11292
11293 if (n < 2)
11294 return 1.0;
11295 else if (n == 4)
11296 return num1 / den1;
11297 else
11298 return num0 / den0;
11299 }
11300
11301
11302 /* Assuming that X is the representation of a value of fixed-point
11303 type TYPE, return its floating-point equivalent. */
11304
11305 DOUBLEST
11306 ada_fixed_to_float (struct type *type, LONGEST x)
11307 {
11308 return (DOUBLEST) x *scaling_factor (type);
11309 }
11310
11311 /* The representation of a fixed-point value of type TYPE
11312 corresponding to the value X. */
11313
11314 LONGEST
11315 ada_float_to_fixed (struct type *type, DOUBLEST x)
11316 {
11317 return (LONGEST) (x / scaling_factor (type) + 0.5);
11318 }
11319
11320 \f
11321
11322 /* Range types */
11323
11324 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
11325 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
11326 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
11327 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
11328 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
11329
11330 static int
11331 scan_discrim_bound (char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
11332 int *pnew_k)
11333 {
11334 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
11335 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
11336 char *bound;
11337 char *pend;
11338 struct value *bound_val;
11339
11340 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
11341 return 0;
11342
11343 pend = strstr (str + k, "__");
11344 if (pend == NULL)
11345 {
11346 bound = str + k;
11347 k += strlen (bound);
11348 }
11349 else
11350 {
11351 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, pend - (str + k) + 1);
11352 bound = bound_buffer;
11353 strncpy (bound_buffer, str + k, pend - (str + k));
11354 bound[pend - (str + k)] = '\0';
11355 k = pend - str;
11356 }
11357
11358 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
11359 if (bound_val == NULL)
11360 return 0;
11361
11362 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
11363 if (pnew_k != NULL)
11364 *pnew_k = k;
11365 return 1;
11366 }
11367
11368 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
11369 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
11370 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
11371
11372 static struct value *
11373 get_var_value (char *name, char *err_msg)
11374 {
11375 struct ada_symbol_info *syms;
11376 int nsyms;
11377
11378 nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN,
11379 &syms);
11380
11381 if (nsyms != 1)
11382 {
11383 if (err_msg == NULL)
11384 return 0;
11385 else
11386 error (("%s"), err_msg);
11387 }
11388
11389 return value_of_variable (syms[0].sym, syms[0].block);
11390 }
11391
11392 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment. If
11393 no such variable found, returns 0, and sets *FLAG to 0. If
11394 successful, sets *FLAG to 1. */
11395
11396 LONGEST
11397 get_int_var_value (char *name, int *flag)
11398 {
11399 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
11400
11401 if (var_val == 0)
11402 {
11403 if (flag != NULL)
11404 *flag = 0;
11405 return 0;
11406 }
11407 else
11408 {
11409 if (flag != NULL)
11410 *flag = 1;
11411 return value_as_long (var_val);
11412 }
11413 }
11414
11415
11416 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
11417 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
11418 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
11419 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. ORIG_TYPE is the
11420 corresponding range type from debug information; fall back to using it
11421 if symbol lookup fails. If a new type must be created, allocate it
11422 like ORIG_TYPE was. The bounds information, in general, is encoded
11423 in NAME, the base type given in the named range type. */
11424
11425 static struct type *
11426 to_fixed_range_type (struct type *raw_type, struct value *dval)
11427 {
11428 const char *name;
11429 struct type *base_type;
11430 char *subtype_info;
11431
11432 gdb_assert (raw_type != NULL);
11433 gdb_assert (TYPE_NAME (raw_type) != NULL);
11434
11435 if (TYPE_CODE (raw_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
11436 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
11437 else
11438 base_type = raw_type;
11439
11440 name = TYPE_NAME (raw_type);
11441 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
11442 if (subtype_info == NULL)
11443 {
11444 LONGEST L = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type);
11445 LONGEST U = ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type);
11446
11447 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX)
11448 return raw_type;
11449 else
11450 return create_static_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), raw_type,
11451 L, U);
11452 }
11453 else
11454 {
11455 static char *name_buf = NULL;
11456 static size_t name_len = 0;
11457 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
11458 LONGEST L, U;
11459 struct type *type;
11460 char *bounds_str;
11461 int n;
11462
11463 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
11464 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
11465 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
11466
11467 subtype_info += 5;
11468 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
11469 n = 1;
11470
11471 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
11472 {
11473 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
11474 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
11475 return raw_type;
11476 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
11477 n += 2;
11478 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
11479 n += 1;
11480 subtype_info += 1;
11481 }
11482 else
11483 {
11484 int ok;
11485
11486 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
11487 L = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
11488 if (!ok)
11489 {
11490 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
11491 L = 1;
11492 }
11493 }
11494
11495 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
11496 {
11497 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
11498 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
11499 return raw_type;
11500 }
11501 else
11502 {
11503 int ok;
11504
11505 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
11506 U = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
11507 if (!ok)
11508 {
11509 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
11510 U = L;
11511 }
11512 }
11513
11514 type = create_static_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type),
11515 base_type, L, U);
11516 TYPE_NAME (type) = name;
11517 return type;
11518 }
11519 }
11520
11521 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
11522
11523 int
11524 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
11525 {
11526 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
11527 }
11528 \f
11529
11530 /* Modular types */
11531
11532 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
11533
11534 int
11535 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
11536 {
11537 struct type *subranged_type = get_base_type (type);
11538
11539 return (subranged_type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
11540 && TYPE_CODE (subranged_type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
11541 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
11542 }
11543
11544 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
11545
11546 ULONGEST
11547 ada_modulus (struct type *type)
11548 {
11549 return (ULONGEST) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
11550 }
11551 \f
11552
11553 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
11554 ---------------------------------
11555
11556 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
11557 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
11558 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
11559 . catchpoints on failed assertions
11560
11561 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
11562 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
11563 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
11564 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
11565 to zero-in on certain situations.
11566
11567 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
11568 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
11569 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
11570 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
11571 of breakpoint_ops.
11572
11573 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
11574 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
11575 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
11576 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
11577 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged. */
11578
11579 /* Ada's standard exceptions.
11580
11581 The Ada 83 standard also defined Numeric_Error. But there so many
11582 situations where it was unclear from the Ada 83 Reference Manual
11583 (RM) whether Constraint_Error or Numeric_Error should be raised,
11584 that the ARG (Ada Rapporteur Group) eventually issued a Binding
11585 Interpretation saying that anytime the RM says that Numeric_Error
11586 should be raised, the implementation may raise Constraint_Error.
11587 Ada 95 went one step further and pretty much removed Numeric_Error
11588 from the list of standard exceptions (it made it a renaming of
11589 Constraint_Error, to help preserve compatibility when compiling
11590 an Ada83 compiler). As such, we do not include Numeric_Error from
11591 this list of standard exceptions. */
11592
11593 static char *standard_exc[] = {
11594 "constraint_error",
11595 "program_error",
11596 "storage_error",
11597 "tasking_error"
11598 };
11599
11600 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
11601
11602 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
11603 for a given executable. */
11604
11605 struct exception_support_info
11606 {
11607 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11608 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
11609 const char *catch_exception_sym;
11610
11611 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11612 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
11613 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
11614
11615 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11616 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
11617 const char *catch_assert_sym;
11618
11619 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
11620 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
11621 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
11622 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
11623 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
11624 };
11625
11626 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
11627 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
11628
11629 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11630 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
11631 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06). */
11632
11633 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
11634 {
11635 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
11636 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11637 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11638 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
11639 };
11640
11641 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11642 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
11643 of the Ada runtime. */
11644
11645 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
11646 {
11647 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
11648 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11649 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11650 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
11651 };
11652
11653 /* Return nonzero if we can detect the exception support routines
11654 described in EINFO.
11655
11656 This function errors out if an abnormal situation is detected
11657 (for instance, if we find the exception support routines, but
11658 that support is found to be incomplete). */
11659
11660 static int
11661 ada_has_this_exception_support (const struct exception_support_info *einfo)
11662 {
11663 struct symbol *sym;
11664
11665 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
11666 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
11667 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. */
11668
11669 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
11670 if (sym == NULL)
11671 {
11672 /* Perhaps we did not find our symbol because the Ada runtime was
11673 compiled without debugging info, or simply stripped of it.
11674 It happens on some GNU/Linux distributions for instance, where
11675 users have to install a separate debug package in order to get
11676 the runtime's debugging info. In that situation, let the user
11677 know why we cannot insert an Ada exception catchpoint.
11678
11679 Note: Just for the purpose of inserting our Ada exception
11680 catchpoint, we could rely purely on the associated minimal symbol.
11681 But we would be operating in degraded mode anyway, since we are
11682 still lacking the debugging info needed later on to extract
11683 the name of the exception being raised (this name is printed in
11684 the catchpoint message, and is also used when trying to catch
11685 a specific exception). We do not handle this case for now. */
11686 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym
11687 = lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, NULL);
11688
11689 if (msym.minsym && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msym.minsym) != mst_solib_trampoline)
11690 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging "
11691 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint "
11692 "in this configuration."));
11693
11694 return 0;
11695 }
11696
11697 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
11698
11699 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
11700 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
11701 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
11702
11703 return 1;
11704 }
11705
11706 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
11707 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
11708
11709 This function will always set the per-inferior exception_info,
11710 or raise an error. */
11711
11712 static void
11713 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
11714 {
11715 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11716
11717 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
11718 if (data->exception_info != NULL)
11719 return;
11720
11721 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
11722 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&default_exception_support_info))
11723 {
11724 data->exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
11725 return;
11726 }
11727
11728 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
11729 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_fallback))
11730 {
11731 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
11732 return;
11733 }
11734
11735 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
11736 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
11737 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
11738 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
11739 applicable. */
11740
11741 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown) != language_ada)
11742 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
11743
11744 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
11745 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
11746 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
11747 in a shared library. */
11748
11749 if (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid) == 0)
11750 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
11751
11752 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
11753 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
11754 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
11755 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
11756 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
11757 supporting this feature. */
11758
11759 error (_("Cannot insert Ada exception catchpoints in this configuration."));
11760 }
11761
11762 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
11763 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
11764 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
11765 to most users. */
11766
11767 static int
11768 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
11769 {
11770 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11771 char *func_name;
11772 enum language func_lang;
11773 int i;
11774 const char *fullname;
11775
11776 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
11777 This cannot be any user code. */
11778
11779 find_frame_sal (frame, &sal);
11780 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
11781 return 1;
11782
11783 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
11784 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
11785 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
11786 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
11787 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
11788
11789 fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
11790 if (access (fullname, R_OK) != 0)
11791 return 1;
11792
11793 /* Check the unit filename againt the Ada runtime file naming.
11794 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
11795 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
11796 too. */
11797
11798 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
11799 {
11800 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
11801 if (re_exec (lbasename (sal.symtab->filename)))
11802 return 1;
11803 if (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab) != NULL
11804 && re_exec (objfile_name (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab))))
11805 return 1;
11806 }
11807
11808 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
11809
11810 find_frame_funname (frame, &func_name, &func_lang, NULL);
11811 if (func_name == NULL)
11812 return 1;
11813
11814 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
11815 {
11816 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
11817 if (re_exec (func_name))
11818 {
11819 xfree (func_name);
11820 return 1;
11821 }
11822 }
11823
11824 xfree (func_name);
11825 return 0;
11826 }
11827
11828 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
11829 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
11830
11831 void
11832 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
11833 {
11834 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
11835 {
11836 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
11837 {
11838 select_frame (fi);
11839 break;
11840 }
11841 }
11842
11843 }
11844
11845 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
11846 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
11847 of the exception is stored.
11848
11849 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
11850
11851 static CORE_ADDR
11852 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
11853 {
11854 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
11855 }
11856
11857 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
11858 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
11859 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
11860 several frames up in the callstack. */
11861
11862 static CORE_ADDR
11863 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
11864 {
11865 int frame_level;
11866 struct frame_info *fi;
11867 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11868 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11869
11870 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
11871 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
11872 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
11873 without checking the name of their associated function. */
11874 fi = get_current_frame ();
11875 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
11876 if (fi != NULL)
11877 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
11878
11879 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11880 while (fi != NULL)
11881 {
11882 char *func_name;
11883 enum language func_lang;
11884
11885 find_frame_funname (fi, &func_name, &func_lang, NULL);
11886 if (func_name != NULL)
11887 {
11888 make_cleanup (xfree, func_name);
11889
11890 if (strcmp (func_name,
11891 data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
11892 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
11893 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
11894 }
11895 }
11896 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11897
11898 if (fi == NULL)
11899 return 0;
11900
11901 select_frame (fi);
11902 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
11903 }
11904
11905 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
11906 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
11907 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
11908
11909 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
11910
11911 static CORE_ADDR
11912 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11913 struct breakpoint *b)
11914 {
11915 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11916
11917 switch (ex)
11918 {
11919 case ada_catch_exception:
11920 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
11921 break;
11922
11923 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
11924 return data->exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
11925 break;
11926
11927 case ada_catch_assert:
11928 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
11929 break;
11930
11931 default:
11932 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11933 break;
11934 }
11935
11936 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
11937 }
11938
11939 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
11940 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
11941 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
11942 and zero is returned. */
11943
11944 static CORE_ADDR
11945 ada_exception_name_addr (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11946 struct breakpoint *b)
11947 {
11948 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
11949
11950 TRY
11951 {
11952 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
11953 }
11954
11955 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
11956 {
11957 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.message);
11958 return 0;
11959 }
11960 END_CATCH
11961
11962 return result;
11963 }
11964
11965 static char *ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string);
11966
11967 /* Ada catchpoints.
11968
11969 In the case of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, the catchpoint will
11970 stop the target on every exception the program throws. When a user
11971 specifies the name of a specific exception, we translate this
11972 request into a condition expression (in text form), and then parse
11973 it into an expression stored in each of the catchpoint's locations.
11974 We then use this condition to check whether the exception that was
11975 raised is the one the user is interested in. If not, then the
11976 target is resumed again. We store the name of the requested
11977 exception, in order to be able to re-set the condition expression
11978 when symbols change. */
11979
11980 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint
11981 breakpoint location. It includes a "struct bp_location" as a kind
11982 of base class; users downcast to "struct bp_location *" when
11983 needed. */
11984
11985 struct ada_catchpoint_location
11986 {
11987 /* The base class. */
11988 struct bp_location base;
11989
11990 /* The condition that checks whether the exception that was raised
11991 is the specific exception the user specified on catchpoint
11992 creation. */
11993 struct expression *excep_cond_expr;
11994 };
11995
11996 /* Implement the DTOR method in the bp_location_ops structure for all
11997 Ada exception catchpoint kinds. */
11998
11999 static void
12000 ada_catchpoint_location_dtor (struct bp_location *bl)
12001 {
12002 struct ada_catchpoint_location *al = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
12003
12004 xfree (al->excep_cond_expr);
12005 }
12006
12007 /* The vtable to be used in Ada catchpoint locations. */
12008
12009 static const struct bp_location_ops ada_catchpoint_location_ops =
12010 {
12011 ada_catchpoint_location_dtor
12012 };
12013
12014 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint.
12015 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
12016 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. */
12017
12018 struct ada_catchpoint
12019 {
12020 /* The base class. */
12021 struct breakpoint base;
12022
12023 /* The name of the specific exception the user specified. */
12024 char *excep_string;
12025 };
12026
12027 /* Parse the exception condition string in the context of each of the
12028 catchpoint's locations, and store them for later evaluation. */
12029
12030 static void
12031 create_excep_cond_exprs (struct ada_catchpoint *c)
12032 {
12033 struct cleanup *old_chain;
12034 struct bp_location *bl;
12035 char *cond_string;
12036
12037 /* Nothing to do if there's no specific exception to catch. */
12038 if (c->excep_string == NULL)
12039 return;
12040
12041 /* Same if there are no locations... */
12042 if (c->base.loc == NULL)
12043 return;
12044
12045 /* Compute the condition expression in text form, from the specific
12046 expection we want to catch. */
12047 cond_string = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (c->excep_string);
12048 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
12049
12050 /* Iterate over all the catchpoint's locations, and parse an
12051 expression for each. */
12052 for (bl = c->base.loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
12053 {
12054 struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
12055 = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
12056 struct expression *exp = NULL;
12057
12058 if (!bl->shlib_disabled)
12059 {
12060 const char *s;
12061
12062 s = cond_string;
12063 TRY
12064 {
12065 exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, bl->address,
12066 block_for_pc (bl->address), 0);
12067 }
12068 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12069 {
12070 warning (_("failed to reevaluate internal exception condition "
12071 "for catchpoint %d: %s"),
12072 c->base.number, e.message);
12073 /* There is a bug in GCC on sparc-solaris when building with
12074 optimization which causes EXP to change unexpectedly
12075 (http://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=56982).
12076 The problem should be fixed starting with GCC 4.9.
12077 In the meantime, work around it by forcing EXP back
12078 to NULL. */
12079 exp = NULL;
12080 }
12081 END_CATCH
12082 }
12083
12084 ada_loc->excep_cond_expr = exp;
12085 }
12086
12087 do_cleanups (old_chain);
12088 }
12089
12090 /* Implement the DTOR method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
12091 exception catchpoint kinds. */
12092
12093 static void
12094 dtor_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
12095 {
12096 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12097
12098 xfree (c->excep_string);
12099
12100 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
12101 }
12102
12103 /* Implement the ALLOCATE_LOCATION method in the breakpoint_ops
12104 structure for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12105
12106 static struct bp_location *
12107 allocate_location_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12108 struct breakpoint *self)
12109 {
12110 struct ada_catchpoint_location *loc;
12111
12112 loc = XNEW (struct ada_catchpoint_location);
12113 init_bp_location (&loc->base, &ada_catchpoint_location_ops, self);
12114 loc->excep_cond_expr = NULL;
12115 return &loc->base;
12116 }
12117
12118 /* Implement the RE_SET method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
12119 exception catchpoint kinds. */
12120
12121 static void
12122 re_set_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
12123 {
12124 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12125
12126 /* Call the base class's method. This updates the catchpoint's
12127 locations. */
12128 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.re_set (b);
12129
12130 /* Reparse the exception conditional expressions. One for each
12131 location. */
12132 create_excep_cond_exprs (c);
12133 }
12134
12135 /* Returns true if we should stop for this breakpoint hit. If the
12136 user specified a specific exception, we only want to cause a stop
12137 if the program thrown that exception. */
12138
12139 static int
12140 should_stop_exception (const struct bp_location *bl)
12141 {
12142 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
12143 const struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
12144 = (const struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
12145 int stop;
12146
12147 /* With no specific exception, should always stop. */
12148 if (c->excep_string == NULL)
12149 return 1;
12150
12151 if (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr == NULL)
12152 {
12153 /* We will have a NULL expression if back when we were creating
12154 the expressions, this location's had failed to parse. */
12155 return 1;
12156 }
12157
12158 stop = 1;
12159 TRY
12160 {
12161 struct value *mark;
12162
12163 mark = value_mark ();
12164 stop = value_true (evaluate_expression (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr));
12165 value_free_to_mark (mark);
12166 }
12167 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
12168 {
12169 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
12170 _("Error in testing exception condition:\n"));
12171 }
12172 END_CATCH
12173
12174 return stop;
12175 }
12176
12177 /* Implement the CHECK_STATUS method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12178 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12179
12180 static void
12181 check_status_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, bpstat bs)
12182 {
12183 bs->stop = should_stop_exception (bs->bp_location_at);
12184 }
12185
12186 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12187 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12188
12189 static enum print_stop_action
12190 print_it_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, bpstat bs)
12191 {
12192 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12193 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12194
12195 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
12196
12197 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
12198 {
12199 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
12200 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12201 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12202 }
12203
12204 ui_out_text (uiout,
12205 b->disposition == disp_del ? "\nTemporary catchpoint "
12206 : "\nCatchpoint ");
12207 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
12208 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
12209
12210 switch (ex)
12211 {
12212 case ada_catch_exception:
12213 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12214 {
12215 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (ex, b);
12216 char exception_name[256];
12217
12218 if (addr != 0)
12219 {
12220 read_memory (addr, (gdb_byte *) exception_name,
12221 sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
12222 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
12223 }
12224 else
12225 {
12226 /* For some reason, we were unable to read the exception
12227 name. This could happen if the Runtime was compiled
12228 without debugging info, for instance. In that case,
12229 just replace the exception name by the generic string
12230 "exception" - it will read as "an exception" in the
12231 notification we are about to print. */
12232 memcpy (exception_name, "exception", sizeof ("exception"));
12233 }
12234 /* In the case of unhandled exception breakpoints, we print
12235 the exception name as "unhandled EXCEPTION_NAME", to make
12236 it clearer to the user which kind of catchpoint just got
12237 hit. We used ui_out_text to make sure that this extra
12238 info does not pollute the exception name in the MI case. */
12239 if (ex == ada_catch_exception_unhandled)
12240 ui_out_text (uiout, "unhandled ");
12241 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exception-name", exception_name);
12242 }
12243 break;
12244 case ada_catch_assert:
12245 /* In this case, the name of the exception is not really
12246 important. Just print "failed assertion" to make it clearer
12247 that his program just hit an assertion-failure catchpoint.
12248 We used ui_out_text because this info does not belong in
12249 the MI output. */
12250 ui_out_text (uiout, "failed assertion");
12251 break;
12252 }
12253 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
12254 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
12255
12256 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12257 }
12258
12259 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12260 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12261
12262 static void
12263 print_one_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12264 struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
12265 {
12266 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12267 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12268 struct value_print_options opts;
12269
12270 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12271 if (opts.addressprint)
12272 {
12273 annotate_field (4);
12274 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr", b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
12275 }
12276
12277 annotate_field (5);
12278 *last_loc = b->loc;
12279 switch (ex)
12280 {
12281 case ada_catch_exception:
12282 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
12283 {
12284 char *msg = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), c->excep_string);
12285
12286 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
12287 xfree (msg);
12288 }
12289 else
12290 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "all Ada exceptions");
12291
12292 break;
12293
12294 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12295 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
12296 break;
12297
12298 case ada_catch_assert:
12299 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "failed Ada assertions");
12300 break;
12301
12302 default:
12303 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12304 break;
12305 }
12306 }
12307
12308 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12309 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12310
12311 static void
12312 print_mention_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12313 struct breakpoint *b)
12314 {
12315 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12316 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12317
12318 ui_out_text (uiout, b->disposition == disp_del ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
12319 : _("Catchpoint "));
12320 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
12321 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
12322
12323 switch (ex)
12324 {
12325 case ada_catch_exception:
12326 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
12327 {
12328 char *info = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), c->excep_string);
12329 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, info);
12330
12331 ui_out_text (uiout, info);
12332 do_cleanups (old_chain);
12333 }
12334 else
12335 ui_out_text (uiout, _("all Ada exceptions"));
12336 break;
12337
12338 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12339 ui_out_text (uiout, _("unhandled Ada exceptions"));
12340 break;
12341
12342 case ada_catch_assert:
12343 ui_out_text (uiout, _("failed Ada assertions"));
12344 break;
12345
12346 default:
12347 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12348 break;
12349 }
12350 }
12351
12352 /* Implement the PRINT_RECREATE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12353 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12354
12355 static void
12356 print_recreate_exception (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12357 struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12358 {
12359 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12360
12361 switch (ex)
12362 {
12363 case ada_catch_exception:
12364 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception");
12365 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
12366 fprintf_filtered (fp, " %s", c->excep_string);
12367 break;
12368
12369 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12370 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception unhandled");
12371 break;
12372
12373 case ada_catch_assert:
12374 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch assert");
12375 break;
12376
12377 default:
12378 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12379 }
12380 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
12381 }
12382
12383 /* Virtual table for "catch exception" breakpoints. */
12384
12385 static void
12386 dtor_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
12387 {
12388 dtor_exception (ada_catch_exception, b);
12389 }
12390
12391 static struct bp_location *
12392 allocate_location_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *self)
12393 {
12394 return allocate_location_exception (ada_catch_exception, self);
12395 }
12396
12397 static void
12398 re_set_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
12399 {
12400 re_set_exception (ada_catch_exception, b);
12401 }
12402
12403 static void
12404 check_status_catch_exception (bpstat bs)
12405 {
12406 check_status_exception (ada_catch_exception, bs);
12407 }
12408
12409 static enum print_stop_action
12410 print_it_catch_exception (bpstat bs)
12411 {
12412 return print_it_exception (ada_catch_exception, bs);
12413 }
12414
12415 static void
12416 print_one_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
12417 {
12418 print_one_exception (ada_catch_exception, b, last_loc);
12419 }
12420
12421 static void
12422 print_mention_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
12423 {
12424 print_mention_exception (ada_catch_exception, b);
12425 }
12426
12427 static void
12428 print_recreate_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12429 {
12430 print_recreate_exception (ada_catch_exception, b, fp);
12431 }
12432
12433 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
12434
12435 /* Virtual table for "catch exception unhandled" breakpoints. */
12436
12437 static void
12438 dtor_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
12439 {
12440 dtor_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
12441 }
12442
12443 static struct bp_location *
12444 allocate_location_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *self)
12445 {
12446 return allocate_location_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, self);
12447 }
12448
12449 static void
12450 re_set_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
12451 {
12452 re_set_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
12453 }
12454
12455 static void
12456 check_status_catch_exception_unhandled (bpstat bs)
12457 {
12458 check_status_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, bs);
12459 }
12460
12461 static enum print_stop_action
12462 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled (bpstat bs)
12463 {
12464 return print_it_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, bs);
12465 }
12466
12467 static void
12468 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b,
12469 struct bp_location **last_loc)
12470 {
12471 print_one_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b, last_loc);
12472 }
12473
12474 static void
12475 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
12476 {
12477 print_mention_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
12478 }
12479
12480 static void
12481 print_recreate_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b,
12482 struct ui_file *fp)
12483 {
12484 print_recreate_exception (ada_catch_exception_unhandled, b, fp);
12485 }
12486
12487 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
12488
12489 /* Virtual table for "catch assert" breakpoints. */
12490
12491 static void
12492 dtor_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
12493 {
12494 dtor_exception (ada_catch_assert, b);
12495 }
12496
12497 static struct bp_location *
12498 allocate_location_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *self)
12499 {
12500 return allocate_location_exception (ada_catch_assert, self);
12501 }
12502
12503 static void
12504 re_set_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
12505 {
12506 re_set_exception (ada_catch_assert, b);
12507 }
12508
12509 static void
12510 check_status_catch_assert (bpstat bs)
12511 {
12512 check_status_exception (ada_catch_assert, bs);
12513 }
12514
12515 static enum print_stop_action
12516 print_it_catch_assert (bpstat bs)
12517 {
12518 return print_it_exception (ada_catch_assert, bs);
12519 }
12520
12521 static void
12522 print_one_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
12523 {
12524 print_one_exception (ada_catch_assert, b, last_loc);
12525 }
12526
12527 static void
12528 print_mention_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
12529 {
12530 print_mention_exception (ada_catch_assert, b);
12531 }
12532
12533 static void
12534 print_recreate_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12535 {
12536 print_recreate_exception (ada_catch_assert, b, fp);
12537 }
12538
12539 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
12540
12541 /* Return a newly allocated copy of the first space-separated token
12542 in ARGSP, and then adjust ARGSP to point immediately after that
12543 token.
12544
12545 Return NULL if ARGPS does not contain any more tokens. */
12546
12547 static char *
12548 ada_get_next_arg (char **argsp)
12549 {
12550 char *args = *argsp;
12551 char *end;
12552 char *result;
12553
12554 args = skip_spaces (args);
12555 if (args[0] == '\0')
12556 return NULL; /* No more arguments. */
12557
12558 /* Find the end of the current argument. */
12559
12560 end = skip_to_space (args);
12561
12562 /* Adjust ARGSP to point to the start of the next argument. */
12563
12564 *argsp = end;
12565
12566 /* Make a copy of the current argument and return it. */
12567
12568 result = xmalloc (end - args + 1);
12569 strncpy (result, args, end - args);
12570 result[end - args] = '\0';
12571
12572 return result;
12573 }
12574
12575 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
12576 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
12577 Set EXCEP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
12578 specified by the user.
12579 If a condition is found at the end of the arguments, the condition
12580 expression is stored in COND_STRING (memory must be deallocated
12581 after use). Otherwise COND_STRING is set to NULL. */
12582
12583 static void
12584 catch_ada_exception_command_split (char *args,
12585 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
12586 char **excep_string,
12587 char **cond_string)
12588 {
12589 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
12590 char *exception_name;
12591 char *cond = NULL;
12592
12593 exception_name = ada_get_next_arg (&args);
12594 if (exception_name != NULL && strcmp (exception_name, "if") == 0)
12595 {
12596 /* This is not an exception name; this is the start of a condition
12597 expression for a catchpoint on all exceptions. So, "un-get"
12598 this token, and set exception_name to NULL. */
12599 xfree (exception_name);
12600 exception_name = NULL;
12601 args -= 2;
12602 }
12603 make_cleanup (xfree, exception_name);
12604
12605 /* Check to see if we have a condition. */
12606
12607 args = skip_spaces (args);
12608 if (startswith (args, "if")
12609 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
12610 {
12611 args += 2;
12612 args = skip_spaces (args);
12613
12614 if (args[0] == '\0')
12615 error (_("Condition missing after `if' keyword"));
12616 cond = xstrdup (args);
12617 make_cleanup (xfree, cond);
12618
12619 args += strlen (args);
12620 }
12621
12622 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
12623 is unexpected. */
12624
12625 if (args[0] != '\0')
12626 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
12627
12628 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
12629
12630 if (exception_name == NULL)
12631 {
12632 /* Catch all exceptions. */
12633 *ex = ada_catch_exception;
12634 *excep_string = NULL;
12635 }
12636 else if (strcmp (exception_name, "unhandled") == 0)
12637 {
12638 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
12639 *ex = ada_catch_exception_unhandled;
12640 *excep_string = NULL;
12641 }
12642 else
12643 {
12644 /* Catch a specific exception. */
12645 *ex = ada_catch_exception;
12646 *excep_string = exception_name;
12647 }
12648 *cond_string = cond;
12649 }
12650
12651 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
12652 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
12653
12654 static const char *
12655 ada_exception_sym_name (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12656 {
12657 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12658
12659 gdb_assert (data->exception_info != NULL);
12660
12661 switch (ex)
12662 {
12663 case ada_catch_exception:
12664 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
12665 break;
12666 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12667 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
12668 break;
12669 case ada_catch_assert:
12670 return (data->exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
12671 break;
12672 default:
12673 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12674 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
12675 }
12676 }
12677
12678 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
12679 of the EX kind. */
12680
12681 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
12682 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12683 {
12684 switch (ex)
12685 {
12686 case ada_catch_exception:
12687 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
12688 break;
12689 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12690 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
12691 break;
12692 case ada_catch_assert:
12693 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
12694 break;
12695 default:
12696 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12697 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
12698 }
12699 }
12700
12701 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
12702 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
12703 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
12704 an exception catchpoint.
12705
12706 The string returned is a newly allocated string that needs to be
12707 deallocated later. */
12708
12709 static char *
12710 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string)
12711 {
12712 int i;
12713
12714 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in
12715 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if
12716 EXCEP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard
12717 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation
12718 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would
12719 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition
12720 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the
12721 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error).
12722
12723 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are
12724 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch
12725 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception
12726 standard.constraint_error".
12727
12728 If an exception named contraint_error is defined in another package of
12729 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a
12730 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named:
12731 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */
12732
12733 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++)
12734 {
12735 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], excep_string) == 0)
12736 {
12737 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&standard.%s)",
12738 excep_string);
12739 }
12740 }
12741 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&%s)", excep_string);
12742 }
12743
12744 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
12745 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
12746
12747 EXCEP_STRING should contain the name of a specific exception that
12748 the catchpoint should catch, or NULL otherwise.
12749
12750 ADDR_STRING returns the name of the function where the real
12751 breakpoint that implements the catchpoints is set, depending on the
12752 type of catchpoint we need to create. */
12753
12754 static struct symtab_and_line
12755 ada_exception_sal (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex, char *excep_string,
12756 char **addr_string, const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
12757 {
12758 const char *sym_name;
12759 struct symbol *sym;
12760
12761 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
12762 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
12763
12764 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
12765 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
12766 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
12767 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
12768
12769 /* We can assume that SYM is not NULL at this stage. If the symbol
12770 did not exist, ada_exception_support_info_sniffer would have
12771 raised an exception.
12772
12773 Also, ada_exception_support_info_sniffer should have already
12774 verified that SYM is a function symbol. */
12775 gdb_assert (sym != NULL);
12776 gdb_assert (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_BLOCK);
12777
12778 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
12779 *addr_string = xstrdup (sym_name);
12780
12781 /* Set OPS. */
12782 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
12783
12784 return find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
12785 }
12786
12787 /* Create an Ada exception catchpoint.
12788
12789 EX_KIND is the kind of exception catchpoint to be created.
12790
12791 If EXCEPT_STRING is NULL, this catchpoint is expected to trigger
12792 for all exceptions. Otherwise, EXCEPT_STRING indicates the name
12793 of the exception to which this catchpoint applies. When not NULL,
12794 the string must be allocated on the heap, and its deallocation
12795 is no longer the responsibility of the caller.
12796
12797 COND_STRING, if not NULL, is the catchpoint condition. This string
12798 must be allocated on the heap, and its deallocation is no longer
12799 the responsibility of the caller.
12800
12801 TEMPFLAG, if nonzero, means that the underlying breakpoint
12802 should be temporary.
12803
12804 FROM_TTY is the usual argument passed to all commands implementations. */
12805
12806 void
12807 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12808 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind,
12809 char *excep_string,
12810 char *cond_string,
12811 int tempflag,
12812 int disabled,
12813 int from_tty)
12814 {
12815 struct ada_catchpoint *c;
12816 char *addr_string = NULL;
12817 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
12818 struct symtab_and_line sal
12819 = ada_exception_sal (ex_kind, excep_string, &addr_string, &ops);
12820
12821 c = XNEW (struct ada_catchpoint);
12822 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, sal, addr_string,
12823 ops, tempflag, disabled, from_tty);
12824 c->excep_string = excep_string;
12825 create_excep_cond_exprs (c);
12826 if (cond_string != NULL)
12827 set_breakpoint_condition (&c->base, cond_string, from_tty);
12828 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
12829 }
12830
12831 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
12832
12833 static void
12834 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
12835 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12836 {
12837 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12838 int tempflag;
12839 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind;
12840 char *excep_string = NULL;
12841 char *cond_string = NULL;
12842
12843 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12844
12845 if (!arg)
12846 arg = "";
12847 catch_ada_exception_command_split (arg, &ex_kind, &excep_string,
12848 &cond_string);
12849 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ex_kind,
12850 excep_string, cond_string,
12851 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
12852 from_tty);
12853 }
12854
12855 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch assert" command.
12856
12857 ARGS contains the command's arguments (or the empty string if
12858 no arguments were passed).
12859
12860 If ARGS contains a condition, set COND_STRING to that condition
12861 (the memory needs to be deallocated after use). */
12862
12863 static void
12864 catch_ada_assert_command_split (char *args, char **cond_string)
12865 {
12866 args = skip_spaces (args);
12867
12868 /* Check whether a condition was provided. */
12869 if (startswith (args, "if")
12870 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
12871 {
12872 args += 2;
12873 args = skip_spaces (args);
12874 if (args[0] == '\0')
12875 error (_("condition missing after `if' keyword"));
12876 *cond_string = xstrdup (args);
12877 }
12878
12879 /* Otherwise, there should be no other argument at the end of
12880 the command. */
12881 else if (args[0] != '\0')
12882 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
12883 }
12884
12885 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
12886
12887 static void
12888 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
12889 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12890 {
12891 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12892 int tempflag;
12893 char *cond_string = NULL;
12894
12895 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12896
12897 if (!arg)
12898 arg = "";
12899 catch_ada_assert_command_split (arg, &cond_string);
12900 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ada_catch_assert,
12901 NULL, cond_string,
12902 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
12903 from_tty);
12904 }
12905
12906 /* Return non-zero if the symbol SYM is an Ada exception object. */
12907
12908 static int
12909 ada_is_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym)
12910 {
12911 const char *type_name = type_name_no_tag (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
12912
12913 return (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF
12914 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK
12915 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_CONST
12916 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED
12917 && type_name != NULL && strcmp (type_name, "exception") == 0);
12918 }
12919
12920 /* Given a global symbol SYM, return non-zero iff SYM is a non-standard
12921 Ada exception object. This matches all exceptions except the ones
12922 defined by the Ada language. */
12923
12924 static int
12925 ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym)
12926 {
12927 int i;
12928
12929 if (!ada_is_exception_sym (sym))
12930 return 0;
12931
12932 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++)
12933 if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), standard_exc[i]) == 0)
12934 return 0; /* A standard exception. */
12935
12936 /* Numeric_Error is also a standard exception, so exclude it.
12937 See the STANDARD_EXC description for more details as to why
12938 this exception is not listed in that array. */
12939 if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "numeric_error") == 0)
12940 return 0;
12941
12942 return 1;
12943 }
12944
12945 /* A helper function for qsort, comparing two struct ada_exc_info
12946 objects.
12947
12948 The comparison is determined first by exception name, and then
12949 by exception address. */
12950
12951 static int
12952 compare_ada_exception_info (const void *a, const void *b)
12953 {
12954 const struct ada_exc_info *exc_a = (struct ada_exc_info *) a;
12955 const struct ada_exc_info *exc_b = (struct ada_exc_info *) b;
12956 int result;
12957
12958 result = strcmp (exc_a->name, exc_b->name);
12959 if (result != 0)
12960 return result;
12961
12962 if (exc_a->addr < exc_b->addr)
12963 return -1;
12964 if (exc_a->addr > exc_b->addr)
12965 return 1;
12966
12967 return 0;
12968 }
12969
12970 /* Sort EXCEPTIONS using compare_ada_exception_info as the comparison
12971 routine, but keeping the first SKIP elements untouched.
12972
12973 All duplicates are also removed. */
12974
12975 static void
12976 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions,
12977 int skip)
12978 {
12979 struct ada_exc_info *to_sort
12980 = VEC_address (ada_exc_info, *exceptions) + skip;
12981 int to_sort_len
12982 = VEC_length (ada_exc_info, *exceptions) - skip;
12983 int i, j;
12984
12985 qsort (to_sort, to_sort_len, sizeof (struct ada_exc_info),
12986 compare_ada_exception_info);
12987
12988 for (i = 1, j = 1; i < to_sort_len; i++)
12989 if (compare_ada_exception_info (&to_sort[i], &to_sort[j - 1]) != 0)
12990 to_sort[j++] = to_sort[i];
12991 to_sort_len = j;
12992 VEC_truncate(ada_exc_info, *exceptions, skip + to_sort_len);
12993 }
12994
12995 /* A function intended as the "name_matcher" callback in the struct
12996 quick_symbol_functions' expand_symtabs_matching method.
12997
12998 SEARCH_NAME is the symbol's search name.
12999
13000 If USER_DATA is not NULL, it is a pointer to a regext_t object
13001 used to match the symbol (by natural name). Otherwise, when USER_DATA
13002 is null, no filtering is performed, and all symbols are a positive
13003 match. */
13004
13005 static int
13006 ada_exc_search_name_matches (const char *search_name, void *user_data)
13007 {
13008 regex_t *preg = user_data;
13009
13010 if (preg == NULL)
13011 return 1;
13012
13013 /* In Ada, the symbol "search name" is a linkage name, whereas
13014 the regular expression used to do the matching refers to
13015 the natural name. So match against the decoded name. */
13016 return (regexec (preg, ada_decode (search_name), 0, NULL, 0) == 0);
13017 }
13018
13019 /* Add all exceptions defined by the Ada standard whose name match
13020 a regular expression.
13021
13022 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13023 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13024 filtering is performed.
13025
13026 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13027 gets pushed. */
13028
13029 static void
13030 ada_add_standard_exceptions (regex_t *preg, VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions)
13031 {
13032 int i;
13033
13034 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++)
13035 {
13036 if (preg == NULL
13037 || regexec (preg, standard_exc[i], 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
13038 {
13039 struct bound_minimal_symbol msymbol
13040 = ada_lookup_simple_minsym (standard_exc[i]);
13041
13042 if (msymbol.minsym != NULL)
13043 {
13044 struct ada_exc_info info
13045 = {standard_exc[i], BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msymbol)};
13046
13047 VEC_safe_push (ada_exc_info, *exceptions, &info);
13048 }
13049 }
13050 }
13051 }
13052
13053 /* Add all Ada exceptions defined locally and accessible from the given
13054 FRAME.
13055
13056 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13057 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13058 filtering is performed.
13059
13060 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13061 gets pushed. */
13062
13063 static void
13064 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (regex_t *preg, struct frame_info *frame,
13065 VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions)
13066 {
13067 const struct block *block = get_frame_block (frame, 0);
13068
13069 while (block != 0)
13070 {
13071 struct block_iterator iter;
13072 struct symbol *sym;
13073
13074 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
13075 {
13076 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
13077 {
13078 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
13079 case LOC_BLOCK:
13080 case LOC_CONST:
13081 break;
13082 default:
13083 if (ada_is_exception_sym (sym))
13084 {
13085 struct ada_exc_info info = {SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym),
13086 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)};
13087
13088 VEC_safe_push (ada_exc_info, *exceptions, &info);
13089 }
13090 }
13091 }
13092 if (BLOCK_FUNCTION (block) != NULL)
13093 break;
13094 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
13095 }
13096 }
13097
13098 /* Add all exceptions defined globally whose name name match
13099 a regular expression, excluding standard exceptions.
13100
13101 The reason we exclude standard exceptions is that they need
13102 to be handled separately: Standard exceptions are defined inside
13103 a runtime unit which is normally not compiled with debugging info,
13104 and thus usually do not show up in our symbol search. However,
13105 if the unit was in fact built with debugging info, we need to
13106 exclude them because they would duplicate the entry we found
13107 during the special loop that specifically searches for those
13108 standard exceptions.
13109
13110 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13111 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13112 filtering is performed.
13113
13114 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13115 gets pushed. */
13116
13117 static void
13118 ada_add_global_exceptions (regex_t *preg, VEC(ada_exc_info) **exceptions)
13119 {
13120 struct objfile *objfile;
13121 struct compunit_symtab *s;
13122
13123 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL, ada_exc_search_name_matches, NULL,
13124 VARIABLES_DOMAIN, preg);
13125
13126 ALL_COMPUNITS (objfile, s)
13127 {
13128 const struct blockvector *bv = COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s);
13129 int i;
13130
13131 for (i = GLOBAL_BLOCK; i <= STATIC_BLOCK; i++)
13132 {
13133 struct block *b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, i);
13134 struct block_iterator iter;
13135 struct symbol *sym;
13136
13137 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
13138 if (ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (sym)
13139 && (preg == NULL
13140 || regexec (preg, SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (sym),
13141 0, NULL, 0) == 0))
13142 {
13143 struct ada_exc_info info
13144 = {SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym), SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)};
13145
13146 VEC_safe_push (ada_exc_info, *exceptions, &info);
13147 }
13148 }
13149 }
13150 }
13151
13152 /* Implements ada_exceptions_list with the regular expression passed
13153 as a regex_t, rather than a string.
13154
13155 If not NULL, PREG is used to filter out exceptions whose names
13156 do not match. Otherwise, all exceptions are listed. */
13157
13158 static VEC(ada_exc_info) *
13159 ada_exceptions_list_1 (regex_t *preg)
13160 {
13161 VEC(ada_exc_info) *result = NULL;
13162 struct cleanup *old_chain
13163 = make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (ada_exc_info), &result);
13164 int prev_len;
13165
13166 /* First, list the known standard exceptions. These exceptions
13167 need to be handled separately, as they are usually defined in
13168 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info. */
13169
13170 ada_add_standard_exceptions (preg, &result);
13171
13172 /* Next, find all exceptions whose scope is local and accessible
13173 from the currently selected frame. */
13174
13175 if (has_stack_frames ())
13176 {
13177 prev_len = VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result);
13178 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (preg, get_selected_frame (NULL),
13179 &result);
13180 if (VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result) > prev_len)
13181 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len);
13182 }
13183
13184 /* Add all exceptions whose scope is global. */
13185
13186 prev_len = VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result);
13187 ada_add_global_exceptions (preg, &result);
13188 if (VEC_length (ada_exc_info, result) > prev_len)
13189 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len);
13190
13191 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
13192 return result;
13193 }
13194
13195 /* Return a vector of ada_exc_info.
13196
13197 If REGEXP is NULL, all exceptions are included in the result.
13198 Otherwise, it should contain a valid regular expression,
13199 and only the exceptions whose names match that regular expression
13200 are included in the result.
13201
13202 The exceptions are sorted in the following order:
13203 - Standard exceptions (defined by the Ada language), in
13204 alphabetical order;
13205 - Exceptions only visible from the current frame, in
13206 alphabetical order;
13207 - Exceptions whose scope is global, in alphabetical order. */
13208
13209 VEC(ada_exc_info) *
13210 ada_exceptions_list (const char *regexp)
13211 {
13212 VEC(ada_exc_info) *result = NULL;
13213 struct cleanup *old_chain = NULL;
13214 regex_t reg;
13215
13216 if (regexp != NULL)
13217 old_chain = compile_rx_or_error (&reg, regexp,
13218 _("invalid regular expression"));
13219
13220 result = ada_exceptions_list_1 (regexp != NULL ? &reg : NULL);
13221
13222 if (old_chain != NULL)
13223 do_cleanups (old_chain);
13224 return result;
13225 }
13226
13227 /* Implement the "info exceptions" command. */
13228
13229 static void
13230 info_exceptions_command (char *regexp, int from_tty)
13231 {
13232 VEC(ada_exc_info) *exceptions;
13233 struct cleanup *cleanup;
13234 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
13235 int ix;
13236 struct ada_exc_info *info;
13237
13238 exceptions = ada_exceptions_list (regexp);
13239 cleanup = make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (ada_exc_info), &exceptions);
13240
13241 if (regexp != NULL)
13242 printf_filtered
13243 (_("All Ada exceptions matching regular expression \"%s\":\n"), regexp);
13244 else
13245 printf_filtered (_("All defined Ada exceptions:\n"));
13246
13247 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(ada_exc_info, exceptions, ix, info); ix++)
13248 printf_filtered ("%s: %s\n", info->name, paddress (gdbarch, info->addr));
13249
13250 do_cleanups (cleanup);
13251 }
13252
13253 /* Operators */
13254 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
13255 below. */
13256 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
13257
13258 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
13259 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
13260 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
13261 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
13262 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
13263 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
13264 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
13265 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
13266 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
13267 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
13268 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
13269 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
13270 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
13271 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
13272 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
13273 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
13274 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
13275 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
13276 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
13277 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
13278
13279 static void
13280 ada_operator_length (const struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp,
13281 int *argsp)
13282 {
13283 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
13284 {
13285 default:
13286 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
13287 break;
13288
13289 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
13290 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
13291 ADA_OPERATORS;
13292 #undef OP_DEFN
13293
13294 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13295 *oplenp = 3;
13296 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
13297 break;
13298
13299 case OP_CHOICES:
13300 *oplenp = 3;
13301 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
13302 break;
13303 }
13304 }
13305
13306 /* Implementation of the exp_descriptor method operator_check. */
13307
13308 static int
13309 ada_operator_check (struct expression *exp, int pos,
13310 int (*objfile_func) (struct objfile *objfile, void *data),
13311 void *data)
13312 {
13313 const union exp_element *const elts = exp->elts;
13314 struct type *type = NULL;
13315
13316 switch (elts[pos].opcode)
13317 {
13318 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13319 case UNOP_QUAL:
13320 type = elts[pos + 1].type;
13321 break;
13322
13323 default:
13324 return operator_check_standard (exp, pos, objfile_func, data);
13325 }
13326
13327 /* Invoke callbacks for TYPE and OBJFILE if they were set as non-NULL. */
13328
13329 if (type && TYPE_OBJFILE (type)
13330 && (*objfile_func) (TYPE_OBJFILE (type), data))
13331 return 1;
13332
13333 return 0;
13334 }
13335
13336 static char *
13337 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
13338 {
13339 switch (opcode)
13340 {
13341 default:
13342 return op_name_standard (opcode);
13343
13344 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
13345 ADA_OPERATORS;
13346 #undef OP_DEFN
13347
13348 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13349 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
13350 case OP_CHOICES:
13351 return "OP_CHOICES";
13352 case OP_NAME:
13353 return "OP_NAME";
13354 }
13355 }
13356
13357 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
13358 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
13359 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
13360
13361 static void
13362 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
13363 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
13364 {
13365 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
13366 {
13367 default:
13368 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
13369 break;
13370
13371 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
13372 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
13373 ADA_OPERATORS;
13374 #undef OP_DEFN
13375
13376 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13377 *oplenp = 3;
13378 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13379 break;
13380
13381 case OP_CHOICES:
13382 *oplenp = 3;
13383 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
13384 break;
13385
13386 case OP_STRING:
13387 case OP_NAME:
13388 {
13389 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13390
13391 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
13392 *argsp = 0;
13393 break;
13394 }
13395 }
13396 }
13397
13398 static int
13399 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
13400 {
13401 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
13402 int oplen, nargs;
13403 int pc = elt;
13404 int i;
13405
13406 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
13407
13408 switch (op)
13409 {
13410 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
13411 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
13412 case OP_ATR_LAST:
13413 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
13414 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
13415 case OP_ATR_MAX:
13416 case OP_ATR_MIN:
13417 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
13418 case OP_ATR_POS:
13419 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
13420 case OP_ATR_TAG:
13421 case OP_ATR_VAL:
13422 break;
13423
13424 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13425 case UNOP_QUAL:
13426 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
13427 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
13428 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
13429 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
13430 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
13431 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
13432 break;
13433 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
13434 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
13435 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
13436 break;
13437 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
13438 break;
13439
13440 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13441 case OP_OTHERS:
13442 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
13443 case OP_POSITIONAL:
13444 case OP_CHOICES:
13445 break;
13446
13447 case OP_NAME:
13448 case OP_STRING:
13449 {
13450 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
13451 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
13452
13453 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
13454 break;
13455 }
13456
13457 default:
13458 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
13459 }
13460
13461 elt += oplen;
13462 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
13463 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
13464
13465 return elt;
13466 }
13467
13468 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
13469
13470 static void
13471 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
13472 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
13473 {
13474 int oplen, nargs, i;
13475 int pc = *pos;
13476 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
13477
13478 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
13479
13480 *pos += oplen;
13481 switch (op)
13482 {
13483 default:
13484 *pos -= oplen;
13485 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
13486 return;
13487
13488 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
13489 fputs_filtered (SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), stream);
13490 return;
13491
13492 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
13493 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13494 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13495 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13496 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13497 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
13498 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
13499 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
13500 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13501 return;
13502
13503 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
13504 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
13505 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
13506 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13507 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13508 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13509 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
13510 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
13511 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
13512 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
13513 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13514 return;
13515
13516 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
13517 case OP_ATR_LAST:
13518 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
13519 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
13520 case OP_ATR_MAX:
13521 case OP_ATR_MIN:
13522 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
13523 case OP_ATR_POS:
13524 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
13525 case OP_ATR_TAG:
13526 case OP_ATR_VAL:
13527 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
13528 {
13529 if (TYPE_CODE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
13530 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0,
13531 &type_print_raw_options);
13532 *pos += 3;
13533 }
13534 else
13535 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13536 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
13537 if (nargs > 1)
13538 {
13539 int tem;
13540
13541 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
13542 {
13543 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
13544 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
13545 }
13546 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13547 }
13548 return;
13549
13550 case UNOP_QUAL:
13551 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
13552 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
13553 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
13554 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13555 return;
13556
13557 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13558 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13559 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13560 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13561 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0,
13562 &type_print_raw_options);
13563 return;
13564
13565 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
13566 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13567 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
13568 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13569 return;
13570
13571 case OP_OTHERS:
13572 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
13573 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13574 return;
13575
13576 case OP_CHOICES:
13577 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
13578 {
13579 if (i > 0)
13580 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
13581 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13582 }
13583 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
13584 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13585 return;
13586
13587 case OP_POSITIONAL:
13588 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13589 return;
13590
13591 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13592 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
13593 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
13594 {
13595 if (i > 0)
13596 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
13597 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13598 }
13599 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13600 return;
13601 }
13602 }
13603
13604 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
13605 and precedences of the operators. */
13606
13607 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
13608 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
13609 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
13610 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
13611 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
13612 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
13613 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
13614 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
13615 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
13616 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13617 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13618 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13619 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13620 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
13621 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
13622 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
13623 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
13624 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
13625 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
13626 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
13627 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
13628 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
13629 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
13630 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
13631 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13632 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13633 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13634 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13635 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13636 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13637 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13638 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13639 {NULL, 0, 0, 0}
13640 };
13641 \f
13642 enum ada_primitive_types {
13643 ada_primitive_type_int,
13644 ada_primitive_type_long,
13645 ada_primitive_type_short,
13646 ada_primitive_type_char,
13647 ada_primitive_type_float,
13648 ada_primitive_type_double,
13649 ada_primitive_type_void,
13650 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
13651 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
13652 ada_primitive_type_natural,
13653 ada_primitive_type_positive,
13654 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
13655 nr_ada_primitive_types
13656 };
13657
13658 static void
13659 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13660 struct language_arch_info *lai)
13661 {
13662 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
13663
13664 lai->primitive_type_vector
13665 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
13666 struct type *);
13667
13668 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int]
13669 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13670 0, "integer");
13671 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long]
13672 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch),
13673 0, "long_integer");
13674 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short]
13675 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch),
13676 0, "short_integer");
13677 lai->string_char_type
13678 = lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char]
13679 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, TARGET_CHAR_BIT, 0, "character");
13680 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float]
13681 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch),
13682 "float", NULL);
13683 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double]
13684 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
13685 "long_float", NULL);
13686 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long]
13687 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch),
13688 0, "long_long_integer");
13689 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double]
13690 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
13691 "long_long_float", NULL);
13692 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural]
13693 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13694 0, "natural");
13695 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive]
13696 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13697 0, "positive");
13698 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void]
13699 = builtin->builtin_void;
13700
13701 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
13702 = lookup_pointer_type (arch_type (gdbarch, TYPE_CODE_VOID, 1, "void"));
13703 TYPE_NAME (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address])
13704 = "system__address";
13705
13706 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL;
13707 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool;
13708 }
13709 \f
13710 /* Language vector */
13711
13712 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
13713
13714 static void
13715 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
13716 {
13717 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1);
13718 }
13719
13720 static int
13721 parse (struct parser_state *ps)
13722 {
13723 warnings_issued = 0;
13724 return ada_parse (ps);
13725 }
13726
13727 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
13728 ada_print_subexp,
13729 ada_operator_length,
13730 ada_operator_check,
13731 ada_op_name,
13732 ada_dump_subexp_body,
13733 ada_evaluate_subexp
13734 };
13735
13736 /* Implement the "la_get_symbol_name_cmp" language_defn method
13737 for Ada. */
13738
13739 static symbol_name_cmp_ftype
13740 ada_get_symbol_name_cmp (const char *lookup_name)
13741 {
13742 if (should_use_wild_match (lookup_name))
13743 return wild_match;
13744 else
13745 return compare_names;
13746 }
13747
13748 /* Implement the "la_read_var_value" language_defn method for Ada. */
13749
13750 static struct value *
13751 ada_read_var_value (struct symbol *var, struct frame_info *frame)
13752 {
13753 const struct block *frame_block = NULL;
13754 struct symbol *renaming_sym = NULL;
13755
13756 /* The only case where default_read_var_value is not sufficient
13757 is when VAR is a renaming... */
13758 if (frame)
13759 frame_block = get_frame_block (frame, NULL);
13760 if (frame_block)
13761 renaming_sym = ada_find_renaming_symbol (var, frame_block);
13762 if (renaming_sym != NULL)
13763 return ada_read_renaming_var_value (renaming_sym, frame_block);
13764
13765 /* This is a typical case where we expect the default_read_var_value
13766 function to work. */
13767 return default_read_var_value (var, frame);
13768 }
13769
13770 const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = {
13771 "ada", /* Language name */
13772 "Ada",
13773 language_ada,
13774 range_check_off,
13775 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
13776 that's not quite what this means. */
13777 array_row_major,
13778 macro_expansion_no,
13779 &ada_exp_descriptor,
13780 parse,
13781 ada_error,
13782 resolve,
13783 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
13784 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
13785 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
13786 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
13787 ada_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */
13788 ada_val_print, /* Print a value using appropriate syntax */
13789 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
13790 ada_read_var_value, /* la_read_var_value */
13791 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
13792 NULL, /* name_of_this */
13793 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
13794 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */
13795 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
13796 NULL, /* Language specific
13797 class_name_from_physname */
13798 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
13799 0, /* c-style arrays */
13800 1, /* String lower bound */
13801 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
13802 ada_make_symbol_completion_list,
13803 ada_language_arch_info,
13804 ada_print_array_index,
13805 default_pass_by_reference,
13806 c_get_string,
13807 ada_get_symbol_name_cmp, /* la_get_symbol_name_cmp */
13808 ada_iterate_over_symbols,
13809 &ada_varobj_ops,
13810 NULL,
13811 NULL,
13812 LANG_MAGIC
13813 };
13814
13815 /* Provide a prototype to silence -Wmissing-prototypes. */
13816 extern initialize_file_ftype _initialize_ada_language;
13817
13818 /* Command-list for the "set/show ada" prefix command. */
13819 static struct cmd_list_element *set_ada_list;
13820 static struct cmd_list_element *show_ada_list;
13821
13822 /* Implement the "set ada" prefix command. */
13823
13824 static void
13825 set_ada_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
13826 {
13827 printf_unfiltered (_(\
13828 "\"set ada\" must be followed by the name of a setting.\n"));
13829 help_list (set_ada_list, "set ada ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
13830 }
13831
13832 /* Implement the "show ada" prefix command. */
13833
13834 static void
13835 show_ada_command (char *args, int from_tty)
13836 {
13837 cmd_show_list (show_ada_list, from_tty, "");
13838 }
13839
13840 static void
13841 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops (void)
13842 {
13843 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
13844
13845 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
13846
13847 ops = &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
13848 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
13849 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exception;
13850 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_exception;
13851 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_exception;
13852 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_exception;
13853 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exception;
13854 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exception;
13855 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exception;
13856 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exception;
13857
13858 ops = &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
13859 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
13860 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exception_unhandled;
13861 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_exception_unhandled;
13862 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_exception_unhandled;
13863 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_exception_unhandled;
13864 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exception_unhandled;
13865 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exception_unhandled;
13866 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled;
13867 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exception_unhandled;
13868
13869 ops = &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
13870 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
13871 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_assert;
13872 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_assert;
13873 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_assert;
13874 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_assert;
13875 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_assert;
13876 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_assert;
13877 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_assert;
13878 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_assert;
13879 }
13880
13881 /* This module's 'new_objfile' observer. */
13882
13883 static void
13884 ada_new_objfile_observer (struct objfile *objfile)
13885 {
13886 ada_clear_symbol_cache ();
13887 }
13888
13889 /* This module's 'free_objfile' observer. */
13890
13891 static void
13892 ada_free_objfile_observer (struct objfile *objfile)
13893 {
13894 ada_clear_symbol_cache ();
13895 }
13896
13897 void
13898 _initialize_ada_language (void)
13899 {
13900 add_language (&ada_language_defn);
13901
13902 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops ();
13903
13904 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class, set_ada_command,
13905 _("Prefix command for changing Ada-specfic settings"),
13906 &set_ada_list, "set ada ", 0, &setlist);
13907
13908 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class, show_ada_command,
13909 _("Generic command for showing Ada-specific settings."),
13910 &show_ada_list, "show ada ", 0, &showlist);
13911
13912 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("trust-PAD-over-XVS", class_obscure,
13913 &trust_pad_over_xvs, _("\
13914 Enable or disable an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types"), _("\
13915 Show whether an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types is activated"),
13916 _("\
13917 This is related to the encoding used by the GNAT compiler. The debugger\n\
13918 should normally trust the contents of PAD types, but certain older versions\n\
13919 of GNAT have a bug that sometimes causes the information in the PAD type\n\
13920 to be incorrect. Turning this setting \"off\" allows the debugger to\n\
13921 work around this bug. It is always safe to turn this option \"off\", but\n\
13922 this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is recommended to NOT change\n\
13923 this option to \"off\" unless necessary."),
13924 NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list);
13925
13926 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
13927 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
13928 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
13929 catch_ada_exception_command,
13930 NULL,
13931 CATCH_PERMANENT,
13932 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
13933 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
13934 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
13935 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
13936 catch_assert_command,
13937 NULL,
13938 CATCH_PERMANENT,
13939 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
13940
13941 varsize_limit = 65536;
13942
13943 add_info ("exceptions", info_exceptions_command,
13944 _("\
13945 List all Ada exception names.\n\
13946 If a regular expression is passed as an argument, only those matching\n\
13947 the regular expression are listed."));
13948
13949 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance, maint_set_ada_cmd,
13950 _("Set Ada maintenance-related variables."),
13951 &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance set ada ",
13952 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_set_cmdlist);
13953
13954 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance, maint_show_ada_cmd,
13955 _("Show Ada maintenance-related variables"),
13956 &maint_show_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance show ada ",
13957 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_show_cmdlist);
13958
13959 add_setshow_boolean_cmd
13960 ("ignore-descriptive-types", class_maintenance,
13961 &ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p,
13962 _("Set whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."),
13963 _("Show whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."),
13964 _("\
13965 When enabled, the debugger will stop using the DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type\n\
13966 DWARF attribute."),
13967 NULL, NULL, &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, &maint_show_ada_cmdlist);
13968
13969 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
13970
13971 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc
13972 (256, htab_hash_string, (int (*)(const void *, const void *)) streq,
13973 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
13974
13975 /* The ada-lang observers. */
13976 observer_attach_new_objfile (ada_new_objfile_observer);
13977 observer_attach_free_objfile (ada_free_objfile_observer);
13978 observer_attach_inferior_exit (ada_inferior_exit);
13979
13980 /* Setup various context-specific data. */
13981 ada_inferior_data
13982 = register_inferior_data_with_cleanup (NULL, ada_inferior_data_cleanup);
13983 ada_pspace_data_handle
13984 = register_program_space_data_with_cleanup (NULL, ada_pspace_data_cleanup);
13985 }
This page took 0.346331 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.